17 0 10 MB
WEBM004000
40-28
PC15R-8
CONTENTS 10 STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-1 20 TESTING AND ADJUSTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-1 30 REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-1 40 MAINTENANCE STANDARD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40-1
PC75R-2
00-2
PC75R-2
The affected pages are indicated by the use of the following marks. It is requested that necessary actions be taken to these pages according to table below.
Mark
Indication
C
Page to be newly
c
Page to be replaced
Replace
Page to be delete
Discard
(
)
Action required Add
Pages having no marks are those previously revised or made additions.
LIST OF REVISED PAGES Mark
Page
Time of Mark revision
00-1 00-2 00-2-1 00-2-2 00-3 00-4 00-5 00-6 00-7 00-8 00-9 00-10 00-11 00-12 00-13 00-14 10-1 10-2 10-3 10-4 10-5 10-6 10-7 10-8 10-9 10-10 10-11 10-12 10-13 10-14 10-15 10-16 10-17 10-18 10-19 10-20 10-21 10-22 10-23 10-24
PC75R-2
Page
10-25 10-26 10-27 10-28 10-29 10-30 10-31 10-32 10-33 10-34 10-35 10-36 10-37 10-38 10-39 10-40 10-41 10-42 10-43 10-44 10-45 10-46 10-47 10-48 10-49 10-50 10-51 10-52 10-53 10-54 10-55 10-56 10-57 10-58 10-59 10-60 10-61 10-62 10-63 10-64 10-65
Time of Mark revision
Page
Time of Mark revision
10-66 10-67 10-68 10-69 10-70 10-71 10-72 10-73 10-74 10-75 10-76 10-77 10-78 10-79 10-80 10-81 10-82 10-83 10-84 10-85 10-86 10-87 10-88 10-89 10-90 10-91 10-92 10-93 10-94 10-95 10-96 10-97 10-98 10-99 10-100 10-101 10-102 10-103 10-104 10-105 10-106
Page
Time of Mark revision
10-107 10-108 10-109 10-110 10-111 10-112 10-113 10-114 10-115 10-116 10-117 20-1 20-2 20-3 20-4 20-5 20-6 20-7 20-8 20-9 20-10 20-11 20-12 20-13 20-14 20-15 20-16 20-17 20-18 20-19 20-20 20-21 20-22 20-23 20-24 20-25 20-26 20-27 20-28 20-29
Time of revision
Page
20-30 20-31 20-32 20-33 20-34 20-35 20-36 20-37 20-38 20-39 20-40 20-41 20-42 20-43 20-44 20-45 20-46 20-47 20-48 20-49 20-50 20-51 20-52 20-53 20-54 20-55 20-56 20-57 20-58 20-59 20-60 20-61 30-1 30-2 30-3 30-4 30-5 30-6 30-7 30-8
00-2-1
Mark
Page
30-9 30-10 30-11 30-12 30-13 30-14 30-15 30-16 30-17 30-18 30-19 30-20 30-21 30-22 30-23 30-24 30-25 30-26 30-27 30-28 30-29 30-30 30-31 30-32 30-33 30-34 30-35 30-36 30-37 30-38 30-39 30-40 30-41 30-42 30-43 30-44 30-45 30-46 30-47 30-48 30-49 30-50 30-51 30-52 30-53 30-54 30-55 30-56 30-57 30-58 30-59 30-60 30-61 30-62 30-63 30-64 30-65
00-2-2
Time of Mark revision
Page
Time of Mark revision
30-66 30-67 30-68 30-69 30-70 30-71 30-72 30-73 30-74 30-75 30-76 30-77 30-78 30-79 30-80 30-81 30-82 30-83 30-84 30-85 30-86 30-87 30-88 30-89 30-90 30-91 30-92 30-93 30-94 30-95 30-96 30-97 30-98 30-99 30-100 30-101 30-102 30-103 30-104 30-105 30-106 30-107 30-108 30-109 30-110 30-111 30-112 30-113 30-114 30-115 30-116 30-117 30-118 30-119 30-120 30-121 30-122
Page
Time of Mark revision
Page
Time of Mark revision
Page
Time of revision
30-123 30-124 40-1 40-2 40-3 40-4 40-5 40-6 40-7 40-8 40-9 40-10 40-11 40-12 40-13 40-14 40-15 40-16 40-17 40-18 40-19 40-20 40-21 40-22 40-23 40-24 40-25 40-26 40-27 40-28 40-29 40-30 40-31 40-32 40-33 40-34 40-35 40-36 40-37 40-38
PC75R-2
IMPORTANT SAFETY NOTICE Proper service and repair is extremely important for the safe operation of your machine. The service and repair techniques recommended by Komatsu and describe in this manual are both effective and safe methods of operation. Some of these operations require the use of tools specially designed by Komatsu for the purpose. and are used to mark safety precautions in this manTo prevent injury to workers, the symbols ual. The cautions accompanying these symbols should always be carefully followed. If any danger arises or may possibly arise, first consider safety, and take necessary steps to face.
SAFETY GENERAL PRECAUTIONS
PREPARATIONS FOR WORK
Mistakes in operation extremely dangerous. Read all the Operation and Maintenance Manual carefully BEFORE operating the machine.
7. Before adding or making any repairs, park the machine on hard, level ground, and block the tracks to prevent the machine from moving.
1. Before carrying out any greasing or repairs, read all the precautions written on the decals which are suck on the machine.
8. Before starting work, lower blade, bucket or any other work equipment to the ground. If this is not possible, use blocks to prevent the work equipment from falling down. In addition, be sure to lock all the control levers and hang warning sign on them.
2. When carrying out any operation, always wear safety shoes and helmet. Do not wear loose work clothes, or clothes with buttons missing. . Always wear safety glasses when hitting parts with a hammer. . Always wear safety glasses when grinding parts with a grinder, etc. 3. If welding repairs are needed, always have a trained, experienced welder carry out the work. When carrying out welding work, always wear welding gloves, apron, glasses, cap and other clothes suited for welding work. 4. When carrying out any operation with two or more workers, always agree on the operating procedure before starting. Always inform your fellow workers before starting any step of the operation. Before starting work, hang UNDER REPAIR signs on the controls in the operator's compartment. 5. Keep all tools in good condition and learn the correct way to use them. 6. Decide a place in the repair workshop to keep tools and removed parts. Always keep the tools and parts in their correct places. Always keep the work area clean and make sure that there is no dirt or oil on the floor. Smoke only in the areas provided for smoking. Never smoke while working.
PC75R-2
9. When disassembling or assembling, support the machine with blocks, jacks or stands before starting work. 10. Remove all mud and oil from the steps or other places used to get on and off the machine. Always use the handrails, ladders or steps when getting on or off the machine. Never jump on or off the machine. If it is impossible to use the handrails, ladders or steps, use a stand to provide safe footing.
PRECAUTIONS DURING WORK 11. When removing the oil filler cap, drain plug or hydraulic pressure measuring plugs, loosen them slowly to prevent the oil from spurting out. Before disconnecting or removing components of the hydraulic circuit and engine cooling circuit, first remove the pressure completely from the circuit. 12. The water and oil in the circuits are not hot when the engine in stopped, so be careful not to get burned. Wait for the oil water to cool before carrying out any work on the cooling water circuits.
00-3
13. Before starting work, remove the leads from the battery. Always remove the lead from the negative ( ± ) terminal first. 14. When raising heavy components, use a hoist or crane. Check that the wire rope, chains and hooks are free from damage. Always use lifting equipment which has ample capacity. Install the lifting equipment at the correct places. Use a hoist or crane and operate slowly to prevent the component from hitting any other part. Do not work with any part still raised by the hoist or crane.
24. Take sure when removing or installing tracks. When removing the track, the track separates suddenly, so never let anyone stand at either end of the track.
15. When removing covers which are under internal pressure or under pressure from a spring, always leave two bolts in position on opposite sides. Slowly release the pressure, then slowly loosen the bolts to remove. 16. When removing components, be careful not to break or damage the wiring. Damage wiring may cause electrical fires. 17. When removing piping, stop the fuel or oil from spilling out. If any fuel or oil drips on to the floor, wipe it up immediately. Fuel or oil on the floor can cause you to slip, or can even start fires. 18. As a general rule, do not use gasoline to wash parts. In particular, use only the minimum of gasoline when washing electrical parts. 19. Be sure to assemble all parts again in their original places. Replace any damage parts with new parts. When installing hoses and wires, be sure that they will not be damaged by contact with other parts when the machine is being operated. 20. When installing high pressure hoses, make sure that they are not twisted. Damaged tubes are dangerous, so be extremely careful when installing tubes for high pressure circuits. Also, check that connecting parts are correctly tightened. 21. When assembling or installing parts, always use specified tightening torques. When installing the parts which vibrate violently or rotate at high speed, be particulary careful to check that they are correctly installed. 22. When aligning two holes, never insert your fingers or hand. 23. When measuring hydraulic pressure, check that the measuring tool is correctly assembled before taking any measurement.
00-4
PC75R-2
FOREWORD This shop manual has been prepared as an aid to improve the quality of repairs by giving the operator an accurate understanding of the product and by showing him the correct way to perform repairs and make judgements. Make sure you understand the contents of this manual and use it to full effect at every opportunity. This shop manual mainly contains the necessary technical information for operations performed in a service workshop. The manual is divided into chapters on each main group of components; these chapters are further divided into the following sections. STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION This section explains the structure and function of each component. It serves not only to give an understanding of the structure, but also serves as reference material for troubleshooting. TESTING AND ADJUSTING This sections explains checks to be made before and after performing repairs, as well as adjustments to be made at completion of the checks and repairs. Troubleshooting charts correlating «Problems» to «Causes» are also included in this section. DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY This section explains the order to be followed when removing, installing, disassembling or assembling each component, as well as precautions to be taken for these operations. MAINTENANCE STANDARD This section gives the judgement standards when inspecting disassembled parts.
NOTE The specifications contained in this shop manual are subject to change at any time and without any notice. Contact your Komatsu distributor for the latest information.
PC75R-2
00-5
HOW TO READ THE SHOP MANUAL
HOW TO READ THE SHOP MANUAL VOLUMES
SYMBOLS
Shop manual are issued as a guide to carry out repairs. These various volumes are designed to avoid duplicating the same information.
In order to make the shop manual greatly chelpful, important points about safety and quality are marked with the following symbols.
DISTRIBUTION AND UPDATING Any additions, amendments or other changes will be sent to Komatsu distributors. Get the most up-to-date information before you start any work.
Symbol
Item
Special safety precautions are necessary when performing the work. Safety
FILING METHOD 1. See the page number on the bottom of the page. File the pages in correct order. 2. Following examples show you how to read the page number.
Item number (10. Structure and function) Consecutive page number for each item
3. Additional pages: additional pages are indicated by a hyphen (-) and number after the page number. Fle as in the example. Example: 10-4 10-4-1 ] Added pages 10-4-2 10-5
Extra special safety precautions are necessary when performing the work because it is under internal pressure.
Caution
Special technical precautions or other precautions for preserving standards are necessary when performing the work.
Weight
Weight of parts or systems. Caution necessary when selecting hoisting wire, or when working posture is important, etc.
Example 10 - 3
Remarks
Parts that require special attention Tightening for the tightening torque during astorque sembly. Coat
Parts to be coated with adhesives and lubricants etc.
Oil, water
Places where oil, water or fuel must be added, and their quantity.
Drain
Places where oil or water must be drained, and quantity to be drained.
REVISED EDITION MARK (1 2 3 ....) When a manual is revised, an edition mark is recorded on the bottom outside corner of the pages.
REVISIONS Revised pages are shown on the LIST OF REVISED PAGES between the title page and SAFETY page.
00-6
PC75R-2
HOISTING INSTRUCTIONS
HOISTING INSTRUCTIONS
Heavy parts (25 kg (55.116lb.) or more) must be lifted with a hoist etc. In the Disassembly and Assembly section, every part weighing 25 kg or more is clearly indicated with the symbol
ing, and a serious accident can result. Hooks have maximum strength at the middle portion.
1. If a part cannot be smoothly removed from the machine by hoisting, the following checks should be made: . Check for removal of all bolts fastening the part to the relative parts. . Check for any part causing interference with the part to be removed. 2. Wire ropes 1) Use adequate ropes depending on the weight of parts to be hoisted, referring to the table below: WIRE ROPES (Standard «S» or «Z» twist ropes without galvanizing) Rope diameter (mm)
Allowable load (tons)
10
1.0
11.2
1.4
12.5
1.6
14
2.2
16
2.8
18
3.6
20
4.4
22.4
5.6
30
10.0
40
18.0
50
28.0
60
40.0
3) Do not sling a heavy load with one rope alone, but sling with two or more ropes symmetrically wound on to the load. Slinging with one rope may cause turning of the load during hoisting, untwisting of the rope, or slipping of the rope from its original winding position on the load, which can cause dangerous accidents.
4) Do not sling a heavy load with ropes forming a wide hanging angle from the hook. When hoisting a load with two or more ropes, the force subjected to each rope will increase with the hanging angles. The table below shows the variation of allowable load (kg) when hoisting is made with two ropes, each of which is allowed to sling up to 1000 kg vertically, at various handing angles. When two ropes sling a load vertically, up to 2000 kg of total weight can be suspended. This weight becomes 1000 kg when two ropes make a 120ë hanging angle. On the other hand, two ropes are subjected to an excessive force as large as 4000 kg if they sling a 2000 kg load at a lifting angle of 150ë.
The allowable load value is estimated to be one-sixth or one-seventh of the breaking strength of the rope used. 2) Sling wire ropes from the middle portion of the hook. Slinging near the edge of the hook may cause the rope to slip off the hook during hoist-
PC75R-2
00-7
STANDARD TIGHTENING TORQUE
STANDARD TIGHTENING TORQUE The following charts give the stardard tightening torques of bolts and nuts. Exceptions are given in sections of «Disassembly and Assembly».
1. STANDARD TIGHTENING TORQUE OF BOLTS AND NUT Thread Pitch of diameter bolts of bolts (mm) (mm)
Width across flat (mm) kgm
Nm
lb. ft.
kgm
Nm
lb. ft.
6
1
10
5
0.96w0.1
9.5w1
7w0.74
1.3w0.15
13.5w1.5
10w1
8
1.25
13
6
2.3w0.2
23w2
17w1.5
3.2w0.3
32.2w3.5
24w2.6
10
1.5
17
8
4.6w0.5
45w4.9
6.5w0.6
6.5w0.6
63w6.5
47w4.8
12
1.75
19
10
7.8w0.8
77w8
11w1
11w1
108w11
80w8
14
2
22
12
12.5w1
122w13
17.5w2
17.5w2
172w18
127w13
16
2
24
14
19.5w2
191w21
141w15
27w3
268w29
198w22
18
2.5
27
14
27w3
262w28
194w21
37w4
366w36
270w26
20
2.5
30
17
38w4
372w40
275w30
53w6
524w57
387w42
22
2.5
32
17
52w6
511w57
377w42
73w8
719w80
531w59
24
3
36
19
66w7
644w70
475w52
92w10
905w98
668w72
27
3
41
19
96w10
945w100
698w74
135w15
1329w140 980w103
30
3.5
46
22
131w14
1287w140
950w103
184w20
1810w190 1336w140
33
3.5
50
24
177w20
1740w200 1282w147
250w27
2455w270 1809w199
36
4
55
27
230w25
2250w250 1658w184
320w35
3150w350 2321w258
39
4
60
±
295w33
2900w330 2137w243
410w45
4050w450 2985w332
This torque table does not apply to bolts or nuts which have to fasten nylon or other parts non-ferrous metal washer. . Nm (Newton meter): 1 Nm = 0.102 kgm (0.737 lb.ft.)
00-8
PC75R-2
STANDARD TIGHTENING TORQUE
2. TIGHTENING TORQUE FOR NUTS OF FLARED Use these torques for nut part of flared. Thread diameter of nut part (mm)
Width across flats of nut part (mm)
TIGHTENING TORQUE kgm
Nm
lb.ft.
1/2" - 20 9/16" - 18 3/4" - 16 7/8" - 14 1.1/16" - 12 1.5/16" - 12 1.5/8" - 12 22 33
17 17 22 27 32 38 50 27 41
2.6w0.5 4w0.5 6.7w2 8w2 9.7w3 17w3 20w5 8w2 20w5
25.5w4.9 39.2w4.9 65.7w19.6 78.5w19.6 95.15w29.4 166.7w29.4 196.2w49 78.5w19.6 196.2w49
18.8w3.6 28.9w3.6 48.4w14.5 57.9w14.5 70.13w21.7 122.9w21.7 144.6w36 57.9w14.5 144.6w36
Superficie surface di tenuta Sealing
Thread diameter of nut part (mm)
Width across flats of nut part (mm)
kgm
Nm
lb.ft.
9/16" - 18
17
2.3 ± 2.5
23 ± 25
17 ± 18.4
11/16" - 16
22
3.4 ± 3.9
33 ± 38
24.3 ± 28
13/16" - 16
24
5.2 ± 5.8
51 ± 57
37.6 ± 42
1" - 14
30
8.2 ± 9.2
80 ± 90
59 ± 66.3
"
1. /16 - 12
36
12.2 ± 13.3
120 ± 130
88.4 ± 95.8
1.7/16" - 12
41
15.3 ± 17.3
150 ± 170
110.5 ± 125.3
1.11/16" - 12
50
18.4 ± 20.4
180 ± 200
132.6 ± 147.4
2" - 12
57
20.4 ± 24.4
200 ± 240
147.4 ± 176.8
3
PC75R-2
TIGHTENING TORQUE
00-9
COATING MATERIALS The recommended coating materials prescribed in Komatsu Shop Manuals are listed below: Nomenclature
Code
Applications
ASL800010 Used to apply rubber pads, rubber gaskets and cork plugs. Used to apply resin, rubber, metallic and non-metallic parts when a fast, strong
ASL800020 seal is needed.
Loctite 222 Used for low resistance locking of screws, check nuts and adjustment nuts. To prevent the loosening of bolts, nuts and plugs and the leakage of oil. Used for
Loctite 242 medium resistance locking of screws and nuts of every type, and for locking keys and bearings.
Adhesives
Loctite 262 Used for high resistant of threaded parts that can be removed with normal tools. Loctite 270 Used for high resistant locking and for sealing threaded parts, bolts and stud bolts. Loctite 542 Used for sealing the union threads for hydraulic tubes. Used for sealing rather exact plane surfaces when the option of possible future
Loctite 573 dismantling is required.
Used for high resistant locking of mechanical components that can be removed
Loctite 601 only after heating
Used to lock cylindrical couplings and for the permanent locking of threaded parts,
Loctite 675 and also to lock shafts to bearings, gears, pulleys, pins, bushings, etc.
Used by itself to seal grease fittings, tapered screw fittings and tapered screw fit-
ASL800060 tings in hydraulic circuits of less than 50 mm in diameter. Gasket sealant
Used by itself on mounting flat surface
Loctite 510 (Clearance between surfaces within 0.2 mm) Used by itself on mounting flat surface
Loctite 518 (Clearance between surfaces within 0.5 mm) Antifriction compound (Lubricant including Molybdenum disulfide)
ASL800040 king, burning or rusting.
Grease (Lithium grease)
ASL800050 facilitation of assembling work.
Vaseline
00-10
Applied to bearings and taper shaft to facilitate press-fitting and to prevent sticApplied to bearings, sliding parts and oil seals for lubrication, rust prevention and
±
Used for protecting battery electrode terminals from corrosion.
PC75R-2
ELECTRIC WIRE CODE
ELECTRIC
ELECTRIC WIRE CODE
In the wiring diagrams various colours and symbols are employed to indicate the thickness of wires. This wire code table will help you understand WIRING DIAGRAMS. Example: R -N 1.5 indicates a cable having a nominal number 1.5 and red coating with black stripe.
CLASSIFICATION BY THICKNESS Nominal number
Copper wire ù of strands (mm) 0.30 0.30 0.30 0.30 0.30 0.40 0.40
Number strands
1 1.5 2.5 4 6 10 50
14 21 35 56 84 84 399
Cross section (mm2) 0.99 1.48 2.47 3.95 5.93 10.55 50.11
Cable O.D. (mm)
Current rating (A)
2.80 3.35 3.80 4.60 5.20 7.10 14
11 14 20 28 37 53 160
CLASSIFICATION BY COLOUR AND CODE Primary Code
A
Colour
Light blue
Code
B
Colour
White
Code
C
Colour
Orange
Code
G
Colour
Yellow
Code
H
Colour
Gray
Code
L
Colour
Blue
Code
M
Colour
Brown
Code
N
Colour
Black
Code
R
Colour
Red
Code
S
Colour
Pink
Code
V
Colour
Green
Code
Z
Colour
Violet
Auxiliary A-G
±
Light blue - Yellow B-G
±
White - Yellow C-V
±
A-N
Light blue - Black B-N
±
Yellow - Red H-R
±
Gray - Pink L-R
L/R
Blue - Red M-N
M/N
Brown - Black ±
±
±
R/N ±
Pink - Black V-B
B-R ±
±
±
Gray - Black ±
±
±
±
±
R-V
± ± ± ±
Green - Black
Z-B
Z-N
±
±
±
±
Violet - Black
± ± ±
±
± ±
±
± ±
± ±
± ±
± ±
±
±
± ±
± ±
± ±
±
±
± ±
±
±
± ±
± ±
± ±
±
±
± ±
±
±
±
±
± ±
±
±
±
±
±
±
±
±
±
± ±
±
±
± ±
±
±
±
±
±
±
±
±
±
±
±
± ±
±
±
±
Green - White Violet - White
±
±
Pink - Yellow V-N
±
±
±
Red - Green S-G
±
±
Brown - Green
±
±
±
±
Blue - White M-V
±
± ±
A/V
Light blue - Green
±
±
L-B
B/R
A-V
White - Red
±
Yellow - Black H-N
±
Light blue - Red
±
Red - Black S-N
A-R
± G-N
± R-N
±
White - Black
Orange - Green G-R
±
±
± ±
COMPOSITION OF THE COLOURS The coloration of two-colour wires is indicated by the composition of the symbols listed. Example: R-N = Red-Black with longitudinal colouring. R/N = Red-Black with transversal colouring.
PC75R-2
00-11
WEIGHT TABLE
This weight table is a guide for use when transporting or handling components. Unit: kg (lb.)
Machine model
PC75R-2
From serial no.
22E5200763-
Engine assembly
380 (837)
Radiator - exchanger
35.5 (78.2)
Hydraulic tank (without hydraulic oil)
60 (132.2)
Fuel tank (without fuel)
40 (88.2)
Revolving frame
765 (1685.3)
Counterweight
1050 (2313.2)
Swing circle
89 (196)
Swing machinery assembly
43 (94.7)
Main pump + gear pump
57 (125.6)
Cabin
250 (550.7)
Seat
32 (70.5)
Seat support
14.5 (32)
Platform
51 (112.4)
Control valve
55 (121.2)
Track frame assembly: . Idler assembly . Sprocket . Final drive . Track roller . Carrier roller
979 (2156.8) 82 (180.6) 35 (77.1) 90 (198.2) 16 (35.2) 11 (24.2)
Track - shoe assembly (standard)
491 (1081.6)
Engine hood
Ð
Front hood
Ð
Swivel joint
36 (79.3)
Swing bracket Boom st
170 (374.5) 300 (661)
1 boom
245 (540)
2nd boom
168 (370)
Arm (L=1700)
125 (275.3)
Arm (L=2100)
167 (368)
Blade
250 (551)
Work equipment (1-piece boom)
Ð
Work equipment (2-piece boom)
Ð
00-12
PC75R-2
TABLE OF OIL AND COOLANT QUANTITIES AMBIENT TEMPERATURE RESERVOIR
KIND OF FLUID
±30 ±20 ±10 0 ±22 ± 4 14 32
10 50
20 58
30 40 85 104
CAPACITY 50ëC 122ëF
1st filling
Change
SAE 10W SAE 20W-20 SAE 30 Engine oil pan
OIL
SAE 40
. API CD
SAE 10W-30
9.4 , 9.4 , (2.48 US.gall) (2.48 US.gall)
SAE 15W-30 SAE 15W-40 Hydraulic circuit Final drive (each) Swing machinery Fuel tank
Engine coolant system
OIL . API CD OIL . API GL5 OIL . API GL5
SAE 10W
70 , 138 , (36.43 US.gall) (18.48 US.gall)
SAE 80W 90
1.7 , 1.7 , (0.45 US.gall) (0.45 US.gall)
SAE 30
1.5 , 1.5 , (0.40 US.gall) (0.40 US.gall)
]
100 , (26.41 US.gall)
Ð
WATER+ ANTI-FREEZE
18 , (4.75 US.gall)
Ð
WATER
18 , (4.75 US.gall)
Ð
PERMANENT LIQUID
18 , (4.75 US.gall)
Ð
FUEL
ASTM D975 N. 2
] ASTM D975 N. 1 ASTM: America Society of Testing and Materials SAE: Society of Automotive Engineers API: American Petroleum Institute MIL: USA Military Specification CCMC: Common Market Constructors Committe Specified capacity: Total amount of oil including oil for components and oil in piping. Refill capacity: Amount of oil needed to refill system during normal inspection and maintenance.
PC75R-2
00-13
NOTE: (1) When fuel sulphur content is less than 0.5%, change oil in the oil pan ebery periodic maintenance hours described in operation and maintenance manual. Change oil according to the following table if fuel sulphur content is above 0.5%. Fuel sulphur content
Oil change interval in engine oil pan
0.5 to 1.0%
1/2 of regular interval
Above 1.0%
1/4 of regular interval
00-14
(2) When starting the engine is weathers temperature below 0ëC, be sure to use engine oil SAE 10W, SAE 20W-20, even if weather temperature goes up to 10ëC day time. (3) Use classification CD as engine oil, if use classification CC, reduce the engine oil change interval to half. (4) Use original products, which have characteristics specifically formulated and approved for the engine, the hydraulic circuit of equipment and for reductions.
PC75R-2
GROUP
10
40-28
PC15R-8
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION
P.T.O. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 2 Power train . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 3 Track frame. . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 5 Idler and recoil spring . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 6 Track roller. . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 7 Carrier roller . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 7 Track shoe . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 8 Swing circle. . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 9 Swing machinery . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 10 Hydraulic circuit diagram (Standard) . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 11 Hydraulic circuit diagram (2-Piece boom). . . .. . . . .. . 13 Hydraulic pump . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 14 9-Spool control valve (Standard). . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 40 10-Spool control valve (Standard+2-Piece boom) . 42 Swing motor . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 70 Center swivel joint .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 74 Travel motor . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 76 Parking brake .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 78
PC75R-2
Brake valve .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 79 Travel motor . . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 81 Reduction gear . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 83 Cylinders . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 84 Servocontrol feed unit . . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 86 Accumulator . . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 91 PPC Valve . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 92 PPC Valve (blade, boom swing, 2-piece boom) . . . . 96 Travel PPC valve .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 100 Boom and arm safety valve . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 105 Blade safety valve. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 106 2-Piece boom safety valve. .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 107 Overload sensor switch . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 108 Solenoid valve . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 109 Electrical diagram (1/3) . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 111 Electrical diagram (2/3) . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 113 Electrical diagram (3/3) . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 115
10-1
P.T.O.
2
1
3 5 4 RKP08290
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
Disc Flywheel Damper (No. 4) Hub Pump
10-2
PC75R-2
POWER TRAIN
1
2
3
4
5
6
1
7 8
9
10 11 12 13
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
Swing motor Swing machinery Swing circle Idler Center swivel joint Control valve Travel acceleration solenoid valve
PC75R-2
8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13.
RKP08110
Brake swing solenoid valve Engine Main hydraulic pump Servocontrol feed unit Gear pump Travel motor
10-3
PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
10-4
PC75R-2
TRACK FRAME
2 3
1
7
10 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
Idler Track frame Carrier roller Sprocket Track roller (No. 5) Track shoe Guard
PC75R-2
5
6
4
8
9
RKP08120
8. Final drive 9. Idler cushion 10. Recoil spring
10-5
IDLER AND RECOIL SPRING
1
A
3
2
4
A
10
5
9
6
8
7
RKP08130
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
Idler Recoil spring Packing Lubricator Support Spring pin
10-6
7. 8. 9. 10.
Bushing Shaft Floating seal Plug
SPECIFICATIONS Amount of oil: 600 cc
PC75R-2
CARRIER ROLLER
2
3
5
4
6
1 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
8
Cover Bearing Roller Seal Ring Shaft Snap ring Lubricating plug
SPECIFICATIONS Amount of oil: 120 cc
7
RKP08140
TRACK ROLLER
3
4
5
6
7
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
Shaft Pin Support Seal Bushing Lubricating plug Roller
SPECIFICATIONS Amount of oil: 250 cc
2
PC75R-2
1
RKP08150
10-7
TRACK SHOE
8 5
9
6
7
4
3 1 2
RKP08160
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9.
Master bushing Master pin Spacer Regular pin Bushing Link Shoe Shoe bolt Shoe nut
10-8
STANDARD SHOE Width: Link pitch:
450 mm (17.73 in.) 140 mm (5.516 in.)
PC75R-2
SWING CIRCLE
7
4
5
1 3 1 Section B-B Sezione B - B
6
Section Sezione A-A A-A
2
C
5
D
8 1
C A
D
Section Sezione C-C C-C
B B B 1
B 6 Section Sezione D-D D-D
C A C
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
Swing circle outer race Swing circle inner race Ball bearing Pin Screw Screw Nut Grease nipple (No. 2)
PC75R-2
RKP08170
SPECIFICATIONS Reduction ratio: 81/10=8.1
10-9
SWING MACHINERY
8
7 9 6 10 5
4
11
3
12
2
1
RKP08180
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9.
Swing pinion (Z=10) Housing No. 2 planetary carrier Ring gear (Z=68) No. 2 sun gear (Z=19) No. 1 planetary carrier No. 1 sun gear (Z=22) Level gauge No. 1 planetary gear (Z=23)
10-10
10. No. 2 planetary gear (Z=24) 11. Bearing lubricator nipple 12. Drain plug SPECIFICATIONS Reduction ratio:
22+68 19+68 ÐÐÐÐÐ XÐÐÐÐÐ =18.732 22 19
PC75R-2
HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT DIAGRAM (STANDARD)
1
4
2 9 7 8 6
Reverse V1
V2
C1
C2
A
Forward
Forward
B
Reverse
A
B
T
Blade cylinder (Ø120xØ60-215)
Raise
Lower
Swing motor Brake unlocked pressure: 18.5±2.5 kg/cm2
Boom cylinder (Ø110xØ70-765) Open
Close
Open
Close
L.H. swing
R.H. swing
Bucket cylinder (Ø85xØ55-665)
Boom swing cylinder (Ø100xØ60-650)
R.H. side equipment
L.H. side equipment
5 3 B
210 kg/cm2
S
MB
MA
Lower
D
Raise
D
P3
P3 C2
Speed Slow
P2
C2
C1
Slow Speed
R.H. travel motor
C1
L.H. travel motor
M1 Ø 0.5
B9
PB9
A8
B8
PB8
A7
B7
P
A6
B6
A5
PB6
PB5
B5
B4 PB4
A4
A3
B3
PB3
A2
B2 PB2 P2
A1
B1 PB1
TSW
TB TC
220 kg/cm2
A9
PC
Ø0,9
R.H. swing
Forward
Reverse
200 kg/cm2
200 kg/cm2
PLS
50 kg/cm2
39.4 kg/cm2
M3 P2
T Ø1 25 kg/cm2
300 kg/cm
2
Ø 0.5
PR
Filter: 10
38 kg/cm2
M2
Ø3 min
L.H. swing
L.H. travel Reverse
R.H. travel Forward
P1 PGA
270 kg/cm2
E
PA9
PA8
PA7
PA6
PA5
PA4
PA3
PA2
PGS PS
PDB TS
PA1
PD
Ø 0,5
PPLS
PLS
ST1 solenoid valve group T A4
A3
A1
PA1
P
PM
PB1 PB5
EV6 PB9
PB8
PA8
PA6
PB6
PA3
PB3
PB4
PB7
PA7
PA4
PB2
PA2
EV5 P1
P2
P1
P2
P3
P4
P1
P2
P3
P4
P2
P1
P4
P3
P2
P1
EV11 A
EV12
70 艎
EV4 P
OP1 solenoid valve group
Exhaust filter 25
B
EV3
B2
T
Boom swing PPC valve
L.H. PPC valve
Travel PPC valve
Hydraulic tank
Suction filter 90
P1 P2
P3 P1
Blade PPC valve
R.H. PPC valve
P1
P4
P4
N
N
P1 P3
P4
P2
P2 P1 P2
PC75R-2
PA3
P3 P2
RKP08192
10-11
PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
10-12
PC75R-2
HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT DIAGRAM (2-PIECE BOOM)
1 4 2 9 8
2-piece boom cylinder (Ø90xØ50-580)
6 5
Boom swing cylinder (Ø100xØ60-650)
Reverse
B
Swing motor Brake unlocked pressure: 18.5±2.5 kg/cm2
V1
V2
C1
C2
A
Forward
Forward
B
Reverse
A
B
T 210 kg/cm2
S
MB
Lower
Blade cylinder (Ø120xØ60-215)
Lower
Raise
Boom cylinder (Ø110xØ70-765) Close
Open
Close
Open
R.H. swing
Arm cylinder (Ø95xØ60-905)
Bucket cylinder (Ø85xØ55-665)
3
L.H. swing
Open
Close
R.H. side equipment
L.H. side equipment
7
MA
D
D
Raise
P3
P3 C2 Speed Slow
P2
C2
C1
Slow Speed
R.H. travel motor
C1
L.H. travel motor
M1 Ø 0.5 B10 PB10
A8
B8 PB8
A7
B7 PB7
A6
B6
PB6
B5 PB5
A5
A4
B4
PB4
B3 PB3
A3
A2
B2 PB2 P2
A1
B1 PB1
TSW
TB TC
PC
Filter: 10
220 kg/cm2
A10
PR
Ø0,9 50 kg/cm2
39.4 kg/cm2 R.H. swing
Forward
Reverse
200 kg/cm2
P2 T Ø1
PA10
PA9
PA8
PA7
PA6
PA5
M2
P1 PGA
E
270 kg/cm2
PA3
PA4
38 kg/cm2
Ø3 min
L.H. swing
L.H. travel Reverse
R.H. travel Forward
25 kg/cm2
300 kg/cm2
Ø 0.5
200 kg/cm2
PLS
M3
PA2
PGS PS
PDB TS
PA1
PD
Ø 0,5
PPLS
PLS
ST1 solenoid valve group T
PA1
P
PM
PB1 PB5
A4
PA3
EV6 PB9
A3
PA10
PB10
PB8
PA8
PA6
PA3
PB6
PB4
PB3
PB7
PA7
PA4
PB2
PA2
EV5 P1
A1
EV11
A
EV12
P1
P2
P1
P2
P3
P1
P4
P2
P3
P4
P2
P1
P
OP1 solenoid valve group
P3
P2
P1
Exhaust filter 25
70 艎
T
2-piece boom PPC valve
Boom swing PPC valve
Travel PPC valve
L.H. PPC valve
P1 P3 P1
Hydraulic tank Suction filter 90
P1 P2
P2
Blade PPC valve
R.H. PPC valve
P1
P4
P4
N
N
P1 P3
P4 P2
P2 P1 P2
PC75R-2
P4
EV4
EV3
B2
P2
B
P3 P2
RKP08202
10-13
HYDRAULIC PUMP a
b
d
c
Z
Y View ZZ Vista
e
f
g
1
h
2
j k
View Y Vista Y RKP08210
a. PPLS Port b. PLS Port c. PGA Port d. PM Port e. PDA Port f. PD Port
10-14
- From control valve (PLS Port) - From control valve (P1 Port) and from servocontrol feed unit (P2 Port) - From control valve (P2 Port) - From ST1 solenoid valve group (A3 Port) - Air breeder Port - Main pump drain
g. PA Port h. PA3 Port j. PGS Port k. PS Port
- To servocontrol feed unit (P1 Port) - From gear pump (PGA Port) - From hydraulic tank - From hydraulic tank
1. Hydraulic pump 2. Gear pump
PC75R-2
1. MAIN HYDRAULIC PUMP
a
c
b
A
A Z
Y View VistaZZ
d
e
B
f
C
C B
g h
View YY Vista
RKP08220
a. b. c. d. e.
PS Port PDA Port PD Port PA Port PLS Port
PC75R-2
-
From hydraulic tank Air breeder Port Main pump drain To servocontrol feed unit From control valve (PLS Port)
f. PPLS Port g. PA3 Port h. PM Port
- From control valve (P1 Port) and from servocontrol feed unit (P2 Port) - From gear pump (PGA Port) - From ST1 solenoid valve group (A3 Port)
10-15
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8 9
10
Section AA-A Sezione -A
Section CC-C Sezione -C
Section B-B
Sezione B - B
RKP08230
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
Shaft Cradle Case Rocker cam Shoe
10-16
6. 7. 8. 9. 10.
Piston Cylinder block Valve plate Spring Servo piston
PC75R-2
FUNCTION . The engine rotation and torque transmitted to the pump shaft is converted into hydraulic energy, and pressurized oil is discharged according to the load. . It is possible to change the delivery amount by changing the swash plate angle.
1
2
3
4
A
B
5
a
6
7
8
RKP10430
STRUCTURE . The cylinder block (7) is supported to the shaft (1) by the spline a, and the shaft (1) is supported by the front and rear bearings.
. The piston (6) carries out relative motion in the axial direction inside each cylinder chamber of the cylinder block (7).
. Tip of the piston (6) is a concave ball, and shoe (5) is caulked to it to form one unit. The piston (6) and the shoe (5) form a spherical bearing.
. The cylinder block (7) seals the pressure oil to the valve plate (8), and carries out relative rotation. This surface is so designed that the oil pressure balance is maintained at a suitable level. And oil inside each cylinder of the cylinder block (7) is sucked in and discharged through the valve plate (8).
. The rocker cam (4) has a flat surface A, and the shoe (5) is always pressed against this surface while sliding in a circular movement. The rocker cam (4) brings high pressure oil at the cylindrical surface B with the cradle (2), which is secured to the case, and forms a static pressure bearing when it slides.
PC75R-2
10-17
OPERATION 1. Pump operation 1 - The cylinder block (7) rotates together with the shaft (1), and the shoe (5) slides on the flat surface «A». At this time, the rocker cam (4) moves along the cylindrical surface «B», so the angle «a» between the center line X of the rocker cam (4) and the inclination of the cylinder block (7) in the axial direction changes. This angle «a» is called the swash plate angle. 2 - When the center line X of the rocker cam (4) maintains the swash plate angle «a» in relation to the axial direction of the cylinder block (7), the flat surface «A» acts as a cam for the shoe (5). By this, the piston (6) slides on the inside of the cylinder block (7), creates a difference between capacities E and F, then suction and discharge of oil for the amount of the difference (F±E) will be carried out. In other words, oil is discharged as the capacity of the chamber E decreases when the cylinder block (7) rotates. In the mean time, the capacity of the chamber F increases, and the oil is sucked at this process. (The figure shows the state of the pump when suction of the chamber F and discharge of the chamber E have completed). 3 - When the center line X of the rocker cam (4) becomes in line with the axial direction of the cylinder block (7) (swash plate angle = 0), the difference between capacities of E and F inside the cylinder block (7) becomes 0. so the pump does not carry out any suction or discharge action of oil. (In actual fact, the swash plate angle never becomes 0). 4 - In other words, discharge amount of the pump is directly proportional to the swash plate angle «a».
1
4
5
7
A
␣ X B
4
RKP10440
5
6
A
F
␣ X
7
E RKP10450
F
X
1
7
E RKP10460
10-18
PC75R-2
2. Control of Discharge Amount . As the swash plate angle «a» becomes larger, difference between the capacities E and F becomes larger, so the discharge amount Q increases. The swash plate angle «a» is changed by the servo piston (10).
2
4
. The servo piston (10) moves in a linear reciprocating motion ( × ) under the signal pressure of PC and LS valve. This linear motion is transmitted to the rocker cam (4), which is supported by the cylindrical surface of the cradle (2), and the rocker cam slides in the semi-circular reciprocating direction ( ). . The upper and lower pressure receiving area of the servo piston (10) are different from each other, and to the pressure chamber of the smaller piston side (upper), discharge pressure (self pressure) PP of the main pump is always introduced. To the pressure chamber of the larger piston side (lower), output pressure PEN of the LS valve is introduced. Movement of the servo piston (10) is controlled by the relationship between pressures PP and PEN and the proportion of the pressure receiving areas of the smaller and larger pistons.
PC75R-2
RKP10470
10-19
2.
PC VALVE, LS VALVE, SERVO PISTON
4
5
6
7
8
a
9
10
11
b
3
2 A
A c B
1
e
B
15
14
Section A A-A Sezione -A
d
13
12
Section BB-B Sezione -B RKP08240
a. PA3 Port b. PM Port c. PA Port d. PLS Port e. PPLS Port
- From gear pump (PGA Port) - From ST1 solenoid valve group (A3 Port) - To servocontrol feed unit (P1 Port) - From control valve (P1 Port) and from servocontrol feed unit (P2 Port) - From control valve (PLS Port)
SERVO PISTON 1. Servo piston 2. Lever 3. Spring
10-20
PC 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11.
VALVE Piston Spring Seat Spring Piston Sleeve Piston Union
LS VALVE 12. Plug 13. Sleeve 14. Spring 15. Piston
PC75R-2
LS VALVE . The LS valve control the pump discharge according to the stroke of the control lever, in other words, the flow demand of the actuator. . The LS valve detects the flow demand of the actuator from the differential pressure DPLS of the discharge amount of the main pump PPLS (from self valve) and the outlet pressure of the control valve PLS, and controls the discharge amount Q of the main pump. (PPLS, PLS and DPLS are the pump pressure, LS pressure and LS differential pressure respectively). . In other words, the LS valve detects the pressure loss (LS differential pressure DPLS) generated according to pump flow passing through the opening area of the spool of the control valve, and controls the discharge amount Q of the pump so that the pressure loss becomes constant. Thus, the discharge amount of the pump is kept proper for the demand of the control valve.
Pump discharge amount Q (ᐍ / min) (gpm)
FUNCTION
21.5 Differential pressure ⌬p (bar) (311.8) (psi) RKP08251
. To the LS valve, the pump pressure (from self reduce valve) P and LS pressure PLS are introduced. The relationship between the LS differential pressure DPLS and the pump discharge amount Q changes as shown in the right chart.
PC75R-2
10-21
OPERATION 1. When the control valve is at «NEUTRAL» position
To the actuator All'utilizzo
PLS Distributore Control valve
PPLS Unità di alimentazione Self reduce valve servocomandi
PP Minimo Minimum
M (Small diameter size) (Lato sezione minore)
3
Y
PP
PP a
14
b
d c
PEN
1 PPLS
x
15
PLS
(Lato sezione maggiore) (Large diameter size) RKP08260
10-22
PC75R-2
. To the spring chamber a of the LS valve, LS pressure PLS is introduced from the outlet of the control valve, and to the chamber b at the end of the sleeve on the opposite side, pump pressure PPLS is introduced through the self reduce valve. . Position of the piston (15) is determined by the combined force of LS pressure PLS and force of the spring (14) and the volume of the pump pressure PPLS. . Before the engine is started, the servo piston (1) is pushed to the lower direction (swash plate angle max. side) by the spring (3). . When the engine is started, if all the control valves are at the «NEUTRAL» positions, the LS pressure PLS becomes 0 cm/cm2 (0 bar (0 psi)) because no pressure oil flows to the outlet side of the control valve. (The spring chamber a is open to the drain circuit through the spool of the control valve). At the same time, the pump pressure PPLS is maintained at the unload pressure of approx. 27 cm/cm2 (26 bar (377 psi)). . Therefore, the piston (15) is pushed to the right side ( ), a path is formed between the Ports c and d, and then the pump pressure PP is led to the chamber X at the large diameter side of the servo piston from the Port d. . Though the pump pressure PP is always introduced to the chamber Y of the small diameter side of the servo piston (1), because the force to the large diameter side is larger due to the difference of the areas at two ends of the servo piston (1), the servo piston (1) is moved to the minimum swash plate angle side ( ).
PC75R-2
10-23
2. When the opening of the control valve is large (lever stroke large)
All'utilizzo To the actuator
PLS Distributore
Control valve
PPLS Unità di alimentazione Self reduce valve servocomandi
PP Maximum Massimo
M (Small diameter size) (Lato sezione minore)
3
Y
PP
f
PP a
14
b
ed c
PEN
1 PPLS
x
15
PLS
(Lato sezione maggiore) (Large diameter size) RKP08270
10-24
PC75R-2
. When the control lever is moved to full-stroke, in other words, as the opening area of the control valve becomes large, the difference of the pump pressure PPLS and the LS pressure PLS (LS differential pressure DPLS) becomes smaller. . LS pressure PLS introduced to the spring chamber a of the LS valve becomes more or less the same as the pump pressure PPLS and the piston (15) is pushed to the left side ( ) by the combined force of the LS pressure and the spring (14), closing the Port c and forming a path between the Ports d and e. . Therefore, the pressure oil functioning to the chamber X at the large diameter side of the servo piston (1) flows to the Port e from the Port d, and then to the Port f of the PC valve. . At this time, since the Port f of the PS valve is open to the drain inside the pump case through the inside of the piston, pressure in the chamber X of the large diameter side of the servo piston also becomes to the drain pressure. . By this, the servo piston (1) is moved to the max. swash plate angle side ( ) by the pump pressure PP functioning to the chamber Y at the small diameter side.
PC75R-2
10-25
3. When the opening of the control valve is small (lever stroke small)
To the actuator All'utilizzo
PLS Distributore Control valve
PPLS Unità di alimentazione Self reduce valve servocomandi
PP Minimo Minimum
M (Small diameter size) (Lato sezione minore)
3
Y
PP
PP a
14
b
d c
PEN
1 PPLS
x
15
PLS
(Lato sezione maggiore) (Large diameter size)
RKP08280
10-26
PC75R-2
. When the control lever is fine-controlled or moved to the «NEUTRAL» position, in other words, as the opening area of the control valve becomes small, the difference of the pump pressure PPLS and the LS pressure PLS (LS differential pressure DPLS) becomes larger. . Function at this time is same as that at "1. When the control valve is at «NEUTRAL» position, that is, the pump pressure PPLS pushes the piston (14) to the right side ( ) and the servo piston (1) is moved to the minimum swash plate angle side. In other words, when the control valve is in the range from the «NEUTRAL» to the opening area small (fine control), if the LS differential pressure DPLS is 21.5 cm/cm2 (21 bar (304.6 psi)) (LS setting differential pressure of the LS valve) and above, the pump swash plate angle functions to the minimum side, and if the LS differential pressure DPls becomes below 21.5 cm/cm2 (21 bar (304.6 psi)) when the control valve opening becomes larger, the pump swash plate angle functions to the maximum side.
PC75R-2
10-27
4. When the pump flow is proper the demand of the control valve
To the actuator All'utilizzo
PLS Control valve Distributore
PPLS Unità di alimentazione Self reduce valve servocomandi
PP Fermo Hold
M (Small diameter size) (Lato sezione minore)
3
Y
PP A2 f
PP a
14
b
A1
ed c
PEN
1 PPLS
x
15
PLS
(Large diameter size) (Lato sezione maggiore) RKP08390
10-28
PC75R-2
. Let us take the pressure receiving area at the large diameter side of the servo piston (1) as A1, pressure receiving area at the small diameter side as A2, pressure functioning to the large diameter side as PEN, and the pressure to the small diameter side as PP. . When the pump flow rate reaches the flow demand of the control valve, the pump pressure PPLS functioning to the Port b of the LS valve balances with the combined force of the LS pressure PLS functioning to the spring chamber a and the spring (14), and the piston (15) stops at the center position. . By this, Ports c, d and e open almost equally, and while flowing to the Port d, a part of the pump pressure from the Port c also flows into the chamber X at the large diameter side of the servo piston (1) after reduced to about half pressure by partially drained into the tank case from the Port e. . At this time, because the relationship of the pressure receiving areas on the servo piston (1) is A2 : A1=1 : 2, the pressure functioning to two ends of the servo piston (1) becomes PP : PEN=2 : 1, so the forces to the two ends of the servo piston (1) becomes 1 : 1, and the servo piston (1) stops at the position, balancing the flow demand of the control valve and the pump discharge. . Spring force is so adjusted that the piston (15) is balanced when PPLS ± PLS=DPLS=21.5 cm/cm2 (21 bar (304.6 psi)). . In other words, the pump discharge is maintained as the opening area of the control valve by maintaining the LS differential pressure DPLS as 21.5 cm/cm2 (21 bar (304.6 psi)) because when the opening area of the control valve is 1/2, the pump swash plate angle becomes 1/2, and when the opening area is 1/4, then the pump swash plate angle becomes also 1/4. . For example, if the opening of the control valve is moved to 3/4 after the piston balanced with the opening of 1/4, the LS differential pressure DPLS once lowers. So, the LS valve is activated to increase the pump discharge, and when the pump swash plate angle rises to 3/4, since the LS differential pressure DPLS rises to 21.5 cm/cm2 (21 bar (304.6 psi)), the piston is balanced at this point.
PC75R-2
10-29
PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
10-30
PC75R-2
PC VALVE (Power Control) FUNCTION . The PC valve carries out an approximate equal horse-power control so that the hydraulic horsepower sucked by the pump does not exceed the engine horse-power by limiting the discharge amount Q to a specified about in relation with the discharge pressure PP, even if the LS valve tries to increase the pump discharge amount Q when the discharge pressure PP becomes high and opening area of the control valve is large. . In other words, when a load becomes large during operation and the pump discharge pressure PP rises, the PC valve reduces the pump discharge amount Q, and when the pump discharge pressure PP lowers, it increases the pump discharge amount Q.
. Since the swing pump is mounted directly on the main pump, when the swing pump is in operation, suction torque of the main pump is reduced by the amount sucked by the swing pump so that the sum of the main pump suction torque and the swing pump suction torque becomes the total suction torque (100%).
Mode system system PP Mode Pump discharge amountQQ(ᐍ(/,min) /min) Portata pompa
. Relationship between the pump discharge pressure PP and the pump discharge amount Q is as shown in the chart. Normally, it is set to the pump suction torque of the standard mode, but when a signal from the mode switching solenoid valve is inputted, the pump suction horsepower lowers by approximately 20% as shown by the light-load mode curve.
Mode system system EE Mode Mode system Mode systemPPwith con pompa swing pump insotto operation di rotazione carico Mode system Mode systemEEwith con pompa swing pump in operation di rotazione sotto carico
Pump discharge pressure P (bar) Pressione pompa PP P (bar) RKP08400
PC75R-2
10-31
FUNCTION 1. When load on the actuator is large (pump discharge pressure is high)
W PLS Control valve Distributore
PPLS Elettrovalvola Mode switch Mode System solenoid valve
Unità di alimentazione Self reduce valve servocomandi
PP
PA3
M
Pompa Swing pump rotazione
y
4
g
f
(Small diameter size) (Lato sezione minore)
5
7 PA3
8
PP PM
2 PP
e
d
PEN
1 PPLS
x
15
PLS
(Large diameter size) (Lato sezione maggiore) RKP08410
10-32
PC75R-2
. When a load on the actuator is large and the pump discharge pressure PP rises, the piston (8) is pushed to the left ( ) due to the relationship of the section areas of S1 and S2 of the piston (S1>S2). . By this action, path is formed between the Ports f and g, at the same time when the pump pressure PP of flows to the Port f from the Port g, when the shut out Port f and drain circuit. . If the LS valve works to increase the pump discharge amount, the spool (15) of the LS valve is shifted to the left side ( ) and the path is formed between the Ports d and e. . Therefore, the pump pressure PP from the Port f of the PC valve flows to the Port d from the Port e of the LS valve, enters into the chamber X at the large diameter side of the servo piston (1), and stops the movement of the servo piston (1). . If the pump discharge pressure PP rises further, the piston (8) moves to the left side ( ), and the servo piston (1) is shifted to the minimum swash plate angle side ( ) by the pressure in the chamber X at the large diameter side. . When the servo piston (1) is shifted to the upper ( ), side, the piston (4) is shifted to the right ( ) side via the lever (2). Because of this, the springs (5) and (7) move to the contraction side, and push back the piston (8) to the right side. . When the piston (8) is pushed back to the right and the path between the Ports f and g is shut out, the upward ( ) movement of the servo piston is stopped. . At this time, the stopping position of the servo piston (1) is higher (close to the minimum swash plate angle side) than that when the pump discharge pressure is lower.
PC75R-2
10-33
2. When load on the actuator becomes small (pump discharge pressure lowers)
W PLS Distributore Control valve
PPLS
PM
Unità di alimentazione Selfservocomandi reduce valve
PP
PA3
M Swing Pompa pump rotazione
Y
g
f
(Small diameter size) (Lato sezione minore)
5
7 PA3
8
PP PM
2 PP
e
d
PEN
1 PLS
x
(Large size) (Lato diameter sezione maggiore) RKP08420
10-34
PC75R-2
. When the load on the actuator becomes small and the pump discharge pressure PP lowers, the piston (8) is pushed to the right ( ) side by the spring force of the springs (5) and (7). . By this action, at the same time when the path between the Ports g and f is shut out, the Port f becomes open to the drain circuit. . At this time, if the LS valve is working to increase the pump discharge amount, because control of the PC valve becomes ineffective, pressure oil the chamber X of the large diameter side of the servo piston (1) flows from the Port d through the Port e of the LS valve and drains into the drain circuit from the Port f of the PC valve. . Therefore, the servo piston (1) is shifted to the maximum swash plate angle ( ) side by the pressure PP in the chamber Y at the small diameter side.
PC75R-2
10-35
3. When the signal pressure is inputted from the mode switch solenoid valve When the swing is operated
To the actuator
PLS Distributore Control valve
PPLS
PM Mode switch Elettrovalvola solenoid valve Mode System
Unità di alimentazione Self reduce valve servocomandi
PP
PA3
M
Swing Pompa pump rotazione
S3PLS ± PA (=A) Thus, the flow is divided less than the proportion of opening areas of the spool. . When the ratio is smaller than 1.00 : PP ± PPB L.H. A), and the LS pressure PLS becomes the same as R.H. A which has the higher load pressure. . By this action, the flow control valve (3) at the L.H. travel side is pushed to the left ( ) by the LS circuit PLS, i.e. the load pressure R.H. A of the R.H. travel, and the opening of the notch a at the left side is closed, shutting off the path between the L.H. and R.H. travel circuits, enabling steering operation. . Furthermore, the damper b is provided to ease the transient characteristics of rapid opening/closing of the path circuit when the spool is rapidly operated.
PC75R-2
10-65
7. Travel LS bypass circuit FUNCTION . When the travel and another actuator are operated at the same time, by increasing the LS throttle amount in the LS circuit PLS which is discarded, and relaxing the pressure compensation precision in the travel circuit, drop in the travel speed is minimized. . The bypass circuit is closed when the travel or another actuator is operated individually.
A1
A2
1
PA
PLS
PLS1 a
PB
2
c
4
RKP03060
OPERATION Normal operation . When the boom spool (1) is operated, the pressure in the LS circuit PLS becomes same as the boom circuit pressure A1. . At the same time, the LS circuit pressure PLS is also introduced to the spring chamber PLS1 of the pressure reducing valve (2) in the travel valve. . Since the travel spool is not operated, the travel actuator circuit is closed, and the check valve (4) in the reducing valve (2) is also closed. . Thus, during individual operation of the boom, the travel LS bypass circuit is closed.
10-66
PC75R-2
A1
A2
1
PA
PLS
PLS1 a
PB
2
c
4
RKP03070
When the travel and another actuator are operated together . When the boom spool (1) is operated, the pressure in the LS circuit PLS becomes same as the boom circuit pressure A1.
. Thus, the LS circuit pressure PLS, which has been the same as the boom circuit pressure A1, flows to the travel circuit A2 and lowers.
. Since the pressure in the boom RAISE actuator circuit is normally higher than that of the travel actuator (A1>A2), the pressure in the spring chamber PLS1 in the reducing valve (2) at the travel side is higher than the travel circuit pressure (PA). . Therefore, the pressure reducing valve (2) moves to the left ( ) side, and the LS pressure in the spring chamber PLS1 from the orifice a pushes and opens the check valve (4), and flows to the travel circuit PA through the path b and the path c.
PC75R-2
10-67
8. Boom and arm regeneration circuit FUNCTION (Explanation by boom) 1. When the boom is being lowered, if the bottom pressure A of the cylinder (1) is higher than the head pressure B, and there is hydraulic drift, this sends the return flow at the bottom end to the head end to increase the cylinder speed by that amount.
1 B A 4 2
T
3 a PP
PLS
RKP03080
OPERATION . When there is hydraulic drift when lowering the boom, the pressure A at the bottom end of the boom cylinder (1) becomes higher than the pressure B at the head end. . At this time, a part of the return flow at the bottom end passes the regeneration passage a of the boom spool (2), pushes the check valve (3) open, and flows to the head end. . As the result, the boom lowering speed is increased.
10-68
PC75R-2
2. When lowering the boom, if the head pressure B of the cylinder (1) is greater than the bottom pressure A, and the operation is in the load process, the check valve (3) closes to shut off the circuit between the head and the bottom sides.
1 B A 4 2
T
3 a
PP
PLS
RKP03090
OPERATION . During a load process such as lowering the boom, etc., the pressure B at the head side of the boom cylinder (1) becomes higher than the pressure A at the bottom side. . At this time, the check valve (3) is closed by the pressure B at the head side and the spring (4), and the passage between the head circuit and the bottom circuit is shut off.
PC75R-2
10-69
SWING MOTOR
A
a B
C
C
B b
A
c
d e
RKP08470
a. S Port- From control valve (TSW Port) b. T Port - To hydraulic tank c. B Port - From ST1 solenoid valve group (A1 Port) d. MB Port - From control valve (A1 Port) e. MA Port - From control valve (B1 Port)
10-70
SPECIFICATIONS Type: LMF40AB-2 Motor capacity: 40.8 cc/rev Rated speed: 1500 rpm Safety valve set pressure: 206 bar (2987.6 psi) Suction valve cracking pressure: max. 0.3 bar (4.35 psi) Brake releasing pressure: 18.1w2.5 bar (262.5w36.25 psi)
PC75R-2
2 3
4 5 6
7
8
9
1
Section B-B Sezione B - B
13 12
11
10
Section AA-A Sezione -A
Section C-C
RKP08480
Sezione C - C
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
Output shaft Case Thrust plate Shoe Piston Center spring Cylinder
PC75R-2
8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14.
Valve plate End cover Brake spring Brake piston Disc Plate Safety valve with suction
10-71
SAFETY VALVE WITH SUCTION FUNCTION . When swing operation is stopped, outlet circuit of the motor is closed by the control valve. However, the motor will run for a while by inertial force, so pressure at the outlet side of the motor will abnormally rise, which may cause damage to the motor. . To avoid such danger, the safety valve releases the abnormally high pressure oil from the outlet side of the motor to the Port S, as well as performing swing brake function. . The suction valve supplies oil of equivalent amount to the oil released by the safety valve from the Port S to the inlet side of the motor to avoid cavitation.
S
OPERATION 1. When swing starts . When the swing control lever is operated to SWING LEFT, pressure oil from the pump will be sent to the Port MA through the control valve. . By this, pressure in the Port MA rises, which generates starting force to the motor, and the motor starts to run.
MA
MB
Control valve Distributore
. Oil coming out of the outlet Port returns to the tank from the Port MB though the control valve.
RKP08490
2. When swing stops . When the swing control lever is returned to the NEUTRAL position, pressure oil from the control valve is not sent to the Port MA. At the same time, return circuit for the oil coming out of the outlet of the motor to the tank is shut off by the control valve.
2
1
. At the Port MB, pressure rises, which generates rotational resistance to the motor, which then acts as braking force to the motor. . When the pressure at the Port MB reaches the set pressure of the safety valve (1), B of the safety valve (1) opens to release the pressure oil in the Port MB to the Port S. . At the Port MA, since the motor runs without being supplied with pressure oil, negative pressure will be generated. When this negative pressure lowers to the set pressure of the suction valve (2), the suction valve (2) opens and oil is sent from the Port S to avoid cavitation.
S
MA
MB
Control valve Distributore RKP08500
10-72
PC75R-2
SWING BRAKE OPERATION Unità di Servocontrol alimentazione feed unit servocomandi
1. When swing brake solenoid valve is deactivated . When the swing brake solenoid valve is deactivated, the pressurized oil from the servocontrol feed unit is shut off and Port B is connected to the tank circuit.
Deactivated Non eccitata
M Elettrovalvola Swing brake freno disolenoid rotazione valve
. Because of this, brake piston (11) is pushed down in the direction of the arrow by brake spring (10), so disc (12) and plate (13) are pushed together and the brake is applied.
10 11 12
a
13
A
RKP08510
2. When swing brake solenoid valve is excited . When the swing brake solenoid valve is excited, the valve is switched, and the pressurized oil from the servocontrol feed unit enters Port B and flows to brake chamber a. . The pressurized oil entering chamber a overcomes the force of brake spring (10), and brake piston (11) is pushed up in the direction of the arrow.
Unità di
Servocontrol alimentazione feed unit servocomandi
Excited Eccitata
M Elettrovalvola Swing brake freno di rotazione solenoid valve
10
. Because of this, disc (12) and plate (13) separate, and the brake is released.
11 a
A
12 13
RKP08520
PC75R-2
10-73
CENTER SWIVEL JOINT
Front machine Fronteofmacchina
2
1
Asse ingressi Inlet axis 2A-4A 2A-4A
3
2a
8a
4
6a
9A
5
7A 8A
3a 1a
5A 6A 4A
Inlet axis Asse ingressi 6A-8A 6A-8A
Asse Inletingressi axis 7A-9A 7A-9A
6 3A
9a
7 5a
2A
8
4a
AsseInlet ingressi axis 1A-3A-5A 1A-3A-5A
1A
10
7a
Vista X X View
9
X FUNCTION 1. Not used 2. Travel acceleration 3. Blade raise 4. Drain 5. Blade lower 6. L.H. travel forward 7. R.H. travel reverse 8. L.H. travel reverse 9. R.H. travel forward 1A. 2A. 3A. 4A. 5A. 6A. 7A. 8A. 9A.
Not used From ST1 solenoid valve group (B2 Port) From control valve (B2 Port) To hydraulic tank From control valve (A2 Port) From control valve (B3 Port) From control valve (B4 Port) From control valve (A3 Port) From control valve (A4 Port)
10-74
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10.
Screw Grease nipple Cover Guard ring O-Ring Seal Rotor O-Ring Body Guard ring
1a. 2a. 3a. 4a. 5a. 6a. 7a. 8a. 9a.
Not used To travel motors (D Port) To blade safety valve (V1 Port) From travel motors (C1 Port) To blade safety valve (V2 Port) To L.H. travel motor (A Port) To R.H. travel motor (A Port) To L.H. travel motor (B Port) To R.H. travel motor (B Port)
RKP10480
PC75R-2
PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
PC75R-2
10-75
TRAVEL MOTOR
b
a
e
d
c RKP08530
a. C1 Port - L.H. travel motor: To swivel joint (4a Port) b. A Port - R.H. travel motor: From swivel joint (7a Port) L.H. travel motor: From swivel joint (6a Port) c. B Port - R.H. travel motor: From swivel joint (9a Port) L.H. travel motor: From swivel joint (8a Port) d. C2 Port - R.H. travel motor: From swivel joint (4a Port) e. D Port - From swivel joint (2a Port)
10-76
SPECIFICATIONS Type: Hydraulic motor Motor capacity:
GMO9VL2-B
Hi speed: 26 rev. Lo speed: 37 rev. Max. working pressure: 314 bar (4554 psi) Brake releasing pressure: 4.5 bar (65.3 psi) Hi-Lo switching pressure: 38.5 bar (558.4 psi) Final drive Number of revolution: 1 ± 62.4
PC75R-2
1
6
2
7
8
9
10
11
13
14
12
15
16
17 5 19 29 20 30 4
3
28 18 26
27
25
24
23
22
21
RKP08540
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10.
Check valve spring Check valve Counterbalance valve Return spring End cap Regulator valve Spring Brake piston Cylinder Piston
PC75R-2
11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20.
Swash plate Crank shaft RVA gear RVB gear Cover Driven gear Drive gear Drain plug Shaft Coupling
21. 22. 23. 24. 25. 26. 27. 28. 29. 30.
Center shaft Case Regulator piston Spindle Floating seal Plate Disc Brake spring Valve plate Check valve
10-77
PARKING BRAKE OPERATION 1. When starting to travel When the travel lever is operated, the pressurized oil from the pump actuates counterbalance valve spool (5), the circuit to the parking brake is opened, and opened check valve and the oil flows into chamber a of brake piston (11), overcomes the force of spring (10), and pushes piston (11) to the left ( ) in the direction of the arrow. When this happens, the force pushing plate (27) and disc (28) together is lost, so plate (27) and disc (28) separate and the brake is released.
11 27
10
28
a 5
Control valve Distributore
M 2- When stopping travel When the travel lever is placed in neutral, counterbalance valve spool (5) returns to the neutral position and the circuit to the parking brake is closed. The pressurized oil in chamber a of brake piston (11) is drained to the case from the orifice of check valve in the brake piston, and brake piston (11) is pushed to the right ( ) in the direction of the discs (27) and (28). As a result the brake is applied.
11 27
10
RKP08550
28
a 5
Control valve Distributore
M
10-78
RKP08560
PC75R-2
BRAKE VALVE . The brake valve consist of a check valve and counterbalance valve in a circuit as shown in the diagram on the right. (Fig. 1)
Distributore Control valve
. The function and operation of each component is as given below. 1. Counterbalance valve, check valve
Valvola Check divalve ritegno
FUNCTION . When travelling down a slope, the weight of the machine makes it try to travel faster than the speed of the motor. As a result, if the machine travels with the engine at low speed, the motor will rotate without load and will run away, which is extremely dangerous. To prevent this, these valves act to make the machine travel according to the engine speed (pump discharge volume).
Valvola
Counterbalance di frenatura valve
RKP08570
Fig. 1
Operation when pressure is supplied
Control valve Distributore
. When the travel lever is operated, the pressurized oil from the control valve is supplied to Port PA. It pushes open check valve (2a) and flows from motor inlet Port MA to motor outlet Port MB. However, the motor outlet Port is closed by check valve (2b) and spool (5), so the pressure at the supply side rises. (Fig. 2).
PB
PA
2a
2b 5
. The pressurized oil at the supply side flows from orifice E1 in spool (5) to chamber S1, and when the pressure in chamber S1 goes above the spool switching pressure, spool (5) is pushed to the right in the direction of the arrow. As a result, Port MB and Port PB are connected, the outlet Port side of the motor is opened, and the motor starts to rotate. (Fig. 3).
MA
MB
RKP08580
Fig. 2
Distributore Control valve
PB
PA E1
5
MA
MB
S1
6
RKP08590
Fig. 3
PC75R-2
10-79
Operation of brake when travelling downhill . If the machine tries to run away when travelling downhill, the motor will turn under no load, so the pressure at the motor inlet Port will drop, and the pressure in chamber S1 through orifice E1 will also drop. When the pressure in chamber S1 drops below the spool switching pressure, spool (5) is returned to the left in the direction of the arrow by spring (6), and outlet Port MB is throttled. As a result, the pressure at the outlet Port side rises, resistance is generated to the rotation of the motor, and prevents running away. In other words, the spool is moved to a position where the pressure at outlet Port MB balances the pressure at the inlet Port and the force generated by the weight of the machine. It throttles the outlet Port circuit and controls the speed according to the discharge volume of the pump.
10-80
Control valve Distributore
PB
PA E1
5
MA
MB
S1
RKP08600
Fig. 4
PC75R-2
TRAVEL MOTOR OPERATION 1) At lo speed (motor rocker cam angle at maximum).
8
c
9
Brake valve
7
32
Travel speed solenoid valve (Y6)
Control valve
Self reducing pressure
p
14
24
a
M RKP08611
. The solenoid valve Y6 is deactivated, so the pilot pressure oil from the self reducing valve does not flow to Port D. For this reason, regulator valve (8) is pushed to the left in the direction of the arrow by spring (9). Because of this, it pushed check valve (32), and the main pressure oil from the control valve to end cover (7) is closed for regulator valve (8). . The pressurized oil in chamber a at regulator piston (24) at the bottom passes through orifice b in regulator valve (8) and is drained to the motor case.
PC75R-2
10-81
2) At High speed (motor rocker cam angle at minimum)
8
c
Brake valve
7
32
Travel speed solenoid valve (Y6)
Control valve
Self reducing pressure
14
24
a
M RKP08621
. The solenoid valve Y6 is excited, so the pilot pressure oil from the charging pump flows to Port D, and pushed regulator valve (8) is pushed to the right in the direction of the arrow. . Because of this, the main pressure oil from the control valve passes through passage c in regulator valve (8), enters regulator piston (24) at the bottom, and pushes regulator piston (24) to the left in the direction of the arrow. . As a result, rocker cam (14) moves in the minimum swash plate angle direction, the motor capacity becomes minimum, and the system is set to Hi speed.
10-82
PC75R-2
REDUCTION GEAR FUNCTION This reduction gear is composed of spur reduction gears (First Reduction) and differential reduction gears (Second Reduction).
1
3 OPERATING PRINCIPLE
2
1. First Reduction Function At the below and left figure, the rotating motion on hydraulic motor is transmitted to the input gear (2) of First Reduction. Then three spur gears (3) engaged with the input gear (2) rotate with reducing the rotating speed. Gear ratio of First Reduction is described as the following. i1=± Zi/Zs Zi=No, of teeth if input gear Zs=No, of teeth of spur gear
3
3 RKP08630
4
2. Second reduction Three spur gears are connected severally to the three crank shaft (4). These crank shafts are input of Second Reduction.. RV gear (5) (6) are fitted up the eccentric crank shaft through bearings. According to rotating of the crank shaft, RV gears revolve (eccentric motion) along pin-gears (7) within hub. As these crank shafts are supported by spindle, hub totates with reducing the speed. Gear ratio of Second Reduction is described as the following. i2=(ZP ± ZR)/ZP ZP=No, of pin ZR=No, of teeth of RV gear Total gear ratio of this reduction gear is described as the following. i=i1 x i2=± Zi/Zs x (ZP ± ZR)/ZP
3 6 5
RKP08840
7 24 23
1
2 3 4
22
8
24 23 22
1
360° -----------2x24 2
23 22
3
24
1 2
360° -----------24 3
4 4
Crank shaft di rotation Rotazione 180° of 180ë dell'albero eccentrico
Crank shaft di rotation Rotazione 360° of 360ë dell'albero eccentrico RKP08650
PC75R-2
10-83
CYLINDERS BOOM
1
2
3
19
4
18
5
6
17
7
16
8
15
9
10
12
14
RKP08710
ARM
1
2
3
19
4
18
5
6
17
7
16
8
15
9
10
14
11
13
12
RKP08720
BUCKET
1
2
3
4
5
6
8
9
10
12
RKP08730
19
10-84
18
17
16
15
14 PC75R-2
BOOM SWING, BLADE, 2-PIECE BOOM (H The figure shows the blade cylinder)
2
1
3
19
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
Head bushing Guard ring Washer Washer Wear ring Piston rod Head cushion plunger
Cylinder
4
5
18
8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14.
6
17
8
16
9
20
12
RKP08740
14
15
15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20.
Washer Wear ring Nut Bottom cushion plunger Bottom side bushing Ball (No. 12) Piston
Washer Cylinder Head-piece Washer Coupling flange Half-flange (No. 2)
Boom
2-piece boom
Arm
Bucket
Boom swing
Blade
Piston rod diameter
70 mm (2.758 in)
50 mm (1.97 in.)
60 mm (2.364 in.)
55 mm (2.167 in.)
60 mm (2.364 in.)
60 mm (2.364 in.)
Cylinder inside diameter
110 mm (4.334 in.)
90 mm (3.546 in.)
95 mm (3.743 in.)
85 mm (3.349 in.)
100 mm (3.94 in.)
120 mm (4.728 in.)
Piston stroke
765 mm (30.141 in.)
580 mm (22.852 in.)
905 mm (35.657 in.)
730 mm (28.762 in.)
650 mm (25.61 in.)
215 mm (8.471 in.)
Max. cylinder length
1965 mm (77.421 in.)
1510 mm (59.494 in.)
2245 mm (88.453 in.)
1810 mm (71.314 in.)
1650 mm (65.01 in.)
790 mm (31.126 in.)
Min. cylinder length
1200 mm (47.28 in.)
930 mm (36.642 in.)
1340 mm (52.796 in.)
1080 mm (42.552 in.)
1000 mm (39.4 in.)
575 mm (22.655 in.)
Piston nut width across flat
70 mm (2.758 in)
Ð
Ð
55 mm (2.167 in.)
Ð
Ð
PC75R-2
10-85
SERVOCONTROL FEED UNIT
a B A
A
B
b
c RKP03960
a. P2 Port - To control valve (P1 Port) b. PR Port - To ST1 solenoid valve group (P Port) c. T Port - To hydraulic tank
10-86
PC75R-2
2 3
11
6
5 Detail Z Z Particolare
4
1 8
7
Z
Section A-A Sezione A -A
10
9
Section B B-B Sezione -B
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11.
RKP03970
Pump case Valve Spring Screw Poppet Spring (reducing valve pilot) Spring (reducing valve main) Spool (reducing valve) Spring (safety valve) Ball Filter
PC75R-2
10-87
OPERATION 1. When engine is stopped
PC
. Poppet (5) is pushed against the seat by spring (6), and the passage from Port PR T is closed.
P2
P1
. Valve (8) is pushed to the left by spring (7), and the passage from Port P1 PR is open. . Valve (2) is pushed to the left by spring (3), so the passage between Port P1 P2 is closed. (See Fig. 1)
T
PR Hydraulic diagram RKP03861
Control valve
P2
2
PC
3
P1
T
PR
7
8
5
6
M PC valve
PPC valve
LS valve
Fig. 1
10-88
RKP03871
PC75R-2
2. At neutral 3. When load pressure P2 is low (when moving down under own weight (boom LOWER or arm IN) Note: When load pressure P2 is lower than output pressure PR of the self-reducing pressure valve. . Valve (2) receives force in the direction to close the passage from Port P1 P2 from spring (3) and pressure PR (when the engine is stopped, the pressure is 0 bar (0 psi)). However, when hydraulic oil flows in from Port P1, the pressure is balanced so that pressure P16 force of spring (3) + (area ùd x pressure PR), and the opening from Port P1 P2 is adjusted so that pressure P1 is kept at a certain value above pressure PR. . When pressure PR goes above the set pressure, poppet (5) opens, and the hydraulic oil flows in the following circuit: Port PR hole a inside spool (8) opening of poppet (5) tank Port T. As a result, a pressure difference is created on both sides of hole a inside spool (8), so spool (8) moves in the direction to close the opening from Port P1 PR. Pressure P1 is reduced to a certain pressure (set pressure) by the amount of opening at this point, and is supplied as pressure PR. (See Fig. 2)
Control valve
P2
d
PC
2
3
P1
T
PR
a
8
7
5
M PC valve
PPC valve
LS valve RKP03881
Fig. 2
Control valve
4. When load pressure P2 is high If load pressure P2 increases and the pump discharge amount also increases because of digging operations, pressure P1 also increases (pressure P1> force of spring (7) + (area ùd x pressure PR), so valve (2) moves to the right to the end of the stroke. As a result, the amount of opening from Port P1 P2 increases and the resistance in the passage is reduced, so the loss of engine horsepower is reduced. . If pressure PR goes above the set pressure, poppet (5) opens and the hydraulic oil flows in the following circuit: Port PR hole a inside spool (8) a opening of poppet (5) tank Port T. As a result, a pressure difference is created on both sides of hole a is inside spool (8), so spool (8) moves in the direction to close the opening from Port P1 PR. Pressure P1 is reduced to a certain pressure (set pressure) by the amount of opening at this point, and is supplied as pressure PR. (See Fig. 3)
P2
d
PC
2
3
P1
T
PR
8
a
7
5
M PC valve
PPC valve
LS valve
Fig. 3
PC75R-2
RKP03891
10-89
5. When there is abnormal high pressure When pressure PR of the self-reducing pressure valve becomes abnormally high, ball (10) pushes against the force of spring (9), separates from the seat, and allows hydraulic oil to flow from output Port PR T, so pressure PR goes down. This action protects the equipment at the destination for the hydraulic pressure supply (PPC valve, electromagnetic valve, etc.) from abnormally high pressure. (See Fig. 4)
M PPC valve
PR
P1
T
10
9 Fig. 4
10-90
RKP03901
PC75R-2
ACCUMULATOR
A
1
RKP03910
B
TECHNICAL DATA
FUNCTION
Servocontrol feed group: Nominal volume: Pre-set pressure: Working pressure:
0.35 , 12 1 kg/cm2 35 ± 45 kg/cm2
. A rubber bag (1) containing nitrogen gas is used in the accumulator. Its function is to maintain oil pressure in the circuit to which the accumulator is connected. OPERATION . When the engine is running, the chamber A of the rubber bag (1) (containing nitrogen) is compressed by the pressurized oil from line B. . If the oil pressure in line B falls below the maximum calibration pressure (even after intensive use), the rubber bag (1) will expand due to the pressure of the nitrogen inside it.
PC75R-2
10-91
PPC VALVE WORK EQUIPMENT
a
b
d
c
B
E
E D B
e
A
10-92
f
C
C L.H. PPC VALVE a. P2 Port - To control valve (PB6 port) (arm close) b. P4 Port - To control valve (PB1 port) (R.H. swing) c. P1 Port - To control valve (PA6 port) (arm open) d. P3 Port - To control valve (PA1 port) (L.H. swing) e. T Port - To ST1 solenoid valve (T port) f. P Port - From ST1 solenoid valve (A4 port)
D
A
RKP01070
R.H. PPC VALVE a. P2 Port - To control valve (PA5 port) (boom raise) b. P4 Port - To control valve (PA7 port) (bucket open) c. P1 Port - To control valve (PB5 port) (boom lower) d. P3 Port - To control valve (PB7 port) (bucket close) e. T Port - To ST1 solenoid valve (T port) f. P Port - From ST1 solenoid valve (A4 port)
PC75R-2
6 5
7
4
8
3 9 10
2 1 Section A-A
Section B-B
Sezione A - A
Sezione B - B
Section DD-D Sezione -D
Section C-C
Sezione C - C
Section EE-E Sezione -E RKP01080
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
Spool Adjusting spring (internal) Return spring (external) Plunger Disc Nut
PC75R-2
7. 8. 9. 10.
Joint Cover Pin Body
10-93
FUNCTION 1. At neutral Ports A and B of the control valve and ports P1 and P2 of the PPC valve are connected to drain chamber D through fine control hole f in spool (1). (Fig. 1)
D f
T P
1 P3 (P1)
A
Control valve
P4 (P2)
B
RKP01091
Fig. 1
2. During fine control (NEUTRAL fine control) When piston (4) starts to be pushed by disc (5), retainer (7) is pushed; spool (1) is also pushed by metering spring (2), and moves down. When this happens, fine control hole f is shut off from drain chamber D, and at almost the same time, it is connected to pump pressure chamber PP, so pilot pressure oil from the control pump passes through fine control hole f and goes from port P1 to port A. When the pressure at port P1 becomes higher, spool (1) is pushed back and fine control hole f is shut off from pump pressure chamber PP. At almost the same time, it is connected to drain chamber D to release the pressure at port P1. When this happens, spool (1) moves up or down so that the force of metering spring (2) is balanced with the pressure at port P1. The relationship in the position of spool (1) and body (8) (fine control hole f is at a point midway between drain hole D and pump pressure chamber PP) does not change until retainer (7) contacts spool (1). Therefore, metering spring (2) is compressed proportionally to the amount of movement of the control lever, so the pressure at port P1 also rises in proportion to the travel of the control lever. In this way, the control valve spool moves to a position where the pressure in chamber A (the same as pressure at port P1) and the force of the control valve spool return spring are balanced. (Fig. 2)
10-94
5 4 3 2
D
f
T P
1
PP P1
A
10
P2
Control valve
B
RKP01101
Fig. 2
PC75R-2
3. During fine control (when the lever is returned) When disc (5) starts to be returned, spool (1) is pushed up by the force of centering spring (3) and the pressure at port P1. When this happens, fine control hole f is connected to drain chamber D and the pressure oil at port P1 is released. If the pressure at port P1 drops too far, spool (1) is pushed down by metering spring (2), and fine control hole f is shut off from drain chamber D. At almost the same time, it is connected to pump pressure chamber PP, and the pump pressure is supplied until the pressure at port P1 recovers to a pressure that corresponds to the lever position. When the spool of the control valve returns, oil in drain chamber D flows in from fine control hole f' in the valve on the side that is not working. The oil passes through port P2 and enters chamber B to fill the chamber with oil. (Fig. 3)
5 4 3 2
D
f
T P f
1
PP P1
A
P2
Control valve
B
RKP01111
Fig. 3
4. At full stroke When disc (5) pushes down piston (4), and retainer (7) pushes down spool (1), fine control hole f is shut off from drain chamber D, and is connected with pump pressure chamber PP. Therefore, the pilot pressure from the control pump passes through fine control hole f and flows to chamber A from port P1, and pushes the control valve spool. The oil returning from chamber B passes from port P2 through fine control hole f' and flows to drain chamber D. (Fig. 4)
5 4 9 D f
T P f
1
PP P1
A
P2
Control valve
Fig. 4
PC75R-2
B
RKP01121
10-95
PPC VALVE (Blade, boom swing, 2-piece boom) A
T P
a
P1
P2 RKP03920
b A
5 4 c
d
6
3
7
2 8 1 Section A-A Sezione A - A a. T port b. P port c. P1 port
d. P2 port
10-96
- To hydraulic tank - From ST1 solenoid valve group (A4 port) - For boom swing: to control valve (PA8 port) For 2-piece boom: to control valve (PA10 port) For blade: to control valve (PA2 port) - For boom swing: to control valve (PB8 port) For 2-piece boom: to control valve (PB10 port) For blade: to control valve (PB2 port)
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
Spool Metering spring (internal) Centering spring (external) Plunger Lever Plate Retainer Body
9 RKP00960
PC75R-2
FUNCTION 1. At neutral Ports A and B of the control valve and ports P1 and P2 of the PPC valve are connected to drain chamber D through fine control hole f in spool (1). (Fig. 1)
D
T P
f 1 P1
A
P2
Control valve
B RKP00971
Fig. 1
2. During fine control (NEUTRAL fine control) When piston (4) starts to be pushed by lever (5), retainer (7) is pushed; spool (1) is also pushed by metering spring (2), and moves down. When this happens, fine control hole f is shut off from drain chamber D, and at almost the same time, it is connected to pump pressure chamber PP, so pilot pressure oil from the control pump passes through fine control hole f and goes from port P1 to port A. When the pressure at port P1 becomes higher, spool (1) is pushed back and fine control hole f is shut off from pump pressure chamber PP. At almost the same time, it is connected to drain chamber D to release the pressure at port P1. When this happens, spool (1) moves up or down so that the force of metering spring (2) is balanced with the pressure at port P1. The relationship in the position of spool (1) and body (8) (fine control hole f is at a point midway between drain hole D and pump pressure chamber PP) does not change until retainer (7) contacts spool (1). Therefore, metering spring (2) is compressed proportionally to the amount of movement of the control lever, so the pressure at port P1 also rises in proportion to the travel of the control lever. In this way, the control valve spool moves to a position where the pressure in chamber A (the same as pressure at port P1) and the force of the control valve spool return spring are balanced. (Fig. 2)
PC75R-2
5 4
D
7 T
2
8
f
P
1
P1
P2 PP
A
Control valve Fig. 2
B RKP00981
10-97
3. During fine control (when the lever is returned) When lever (5) starts to be returned, spool (1) is pushed up by the force of centering spring (3) and the pressure at port P1. When this happens, fine control hole f is connected to drain chamber D and the pressure oil at port P1 is released. If the pressure at port P1 drops too far, spool (1) is pushed down by metering spring (2), and fine control hole f is shut off from drain chamber D. At almost the same time, it is connected to pump pressure chamber PP, and the pump pressure is supplied until the pressure at port P1 recovers to a pressure that corresponds to the lever position. When the spool of the control valve returns, oil in drain chamber D flows in from fine control hole f' in the valve on the side that is not working. The oil passes through port P2 and enters chamber B to fill the chamber with oil. (Fig. 3)
5 4
7
D T
2 P
f
f'
1
P2
P1
A
Control valve
PP
B RKP00991
Fig. 3
4. At full stroke When lever (5) pushes down piston (4), and retainer (7) pushes down spool (1), fine control hole f is shut off from drain chamber D, and is connected with pump pressure chamber PP. Therefore, the pilot pressure from the control pump passes through fine control hole f and flows to chamber A from port P1, and pushes the control valve spool. The oil returning from chamber B passes from port P2 through fine control hole f' and flows to drain chamber D. (Fig. 4)
5 4
7
D T
2
8 P
f
f'
1
P1
A
P2
Control valve Fig. 4
10-98
PP
B RKP01001
PC75R-2
PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
PC75R-2
10-99
TRAVEL PPC VALVE
D
D
B
a
B A
A View Z Vista Z
C
Z
b C
a. P port b. c. d. e. f.
T port P1 port P3 port P2 port P4 port
10-100
e
c
f
d
- From ST1 solenoid valve group (A4 port) - To hydraulic tank - To control valve (PA3 port) - To control valve (PB7 port) - To control valve (PB3 port) - To control valve (PA7 port)
RKP03990
FUNCTIONS P1 port L.H. travel (Reverse) P2 port L.H. travel (Forward) P3 port R.H. travel (Reverse) P4 port R.H. travel (Forward)
PC75R-2
8 1 2
3
7 6
4 5 SectionAA-A Sezione -A
Section C-C
Sezione C - C
Section Sezione B-B B-B
Section D-D Sezione D - D RKP04000
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
Piston Plate Collar Body Valve Measuring spring (internal) Centering spring (external) Bolt
PC75R-2
10-101
OPERATION 1. At neutral Ports A and B of the control valve and ports P1 and P2 of the PPC valve are connected to drain chamber D through fine control hole f in spool (1). (Fig. 1).
D
f T P
1 P2
P1
A
Control valve
B RKP04011
Fig. 1
2. During fine control (NEUTRAL Fine control) When the piston (4) starts to be pushed by lever (5), retainer (9) is pushed, valve (1) is also pushed by metering spring (2), and moves down. When this happens, the fine control hole f is shut off from drain chamber D, and at almost the same time, it is connected to pump pressure chamber PP, so pilot pressure oil from the charging pump passes through fine control hole f and goes from port P1 to port A. When the pressure at port P1 becomes higher, valve (1) is pushed back and fine control hole f is shut off from pump pressure chamber PP. At almost the same time, it is connected to drain chamber D to release the pressure at port P1. When this happens, valve (1) moves up or down so that the force of metering spring (2) is balanced with the pressure at port P1. The relationship in the position of valve (1) and body (10) (fine control hole f is at a point midway between drain hole D and pump pressure chamber PP) does not change until retainer (9) contacts valve (1). Therefore, metering spring (2) is compressed proportionally to the amount of movement of the control lever, so the pressure at port P1 also rises in proportion to the travel of the control lever. In this way, the control valve spool moves to a position where the pressure in chamber A (the same as the pressure at port P1) and the force of the control valve spool return spring are balanced. (Fig. 2)
5
4 9
D
2 f
T P
1 PP P2
P1
10 A
Control valve Fig. 2
10-102
B RKP04021
PC75R-2
3. During fine control (when the lever is returned) When lever (5) starts to be returned, valve (1) is pushed up by the force of centering spring (3) and the pressure at port P1. When this happens, fine control hole f is connected to drain chamber D and the pressure oil at port P1 is released. If the pressure at port P1 drops too far, valve (1) is pushed down by metering spring (2), and fine control hole f is shut off from drain chamber D. At almost the same time, it is connected to pump pressure chamber PP, and the pump pressure is supplied until the pressure at port P1 recovers to a pressure that corresponds to the lever position. When the spool of the control valve returns, oil in drain chamber D flows in from fine control hole f' in the valve on the side that is not working. The oil passes through port P2 and enters chamber B to fill the chamber with oil. (Fig. 3).
5 3
D
2 f
T P
f' 1 PP P2
P1
A
Control valve
B RKP04031
Fig. 3
4. At full stroke When lever (5) pushes down piston (4), and retainer (9) pushes down valve (1), fine control hole f is shut off from drain chamber D, and is connected with pump pressure chamber PP. Therefore, the pilot pressure oil from the charging pump passes through fine control hole f and flows to chamber A from port P1, and pushes the control valve spool. The oil returning from chamber B passes from port P2 through fine control hole f' and flows to drain chamber D. (Fig. 4)
5 4 D
9 f
T P
f' 1 PP P2
P1
A
Control valve Fig. 4
PC75R-2
B RKP04041
10-103
PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
10-104
PC75R-2
BOOM AND ARM SAFETY VALVE
b
a
c 1
d
2
3 4
5
e
RKP04170
PC75R-2
20 (290)
2
16 (232) C
- To hydraulic tank - For boom: From control valve (PB5 Port) For arm: From control valve (PB6 Port) c. V2 Port - For boom: From control valve (A5 Port) For arm: From control valve (A6 Port) d. C2 Port - For boom: To the cylinder (Bottom side) For arm: To the cylinder (Head side) e. M Port - For boom: To the overload sensor switch
12 (174)
➔
➔
a. T Port b. P Port
SPECIFICATIONS Pilot ratio: 22 : 1
V2
V2
Screw Valve Rod Nut Nut
Differential pressure ⌬p bar (PSI)
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
C2
8 (116) 4 (58) 0
0
25 (6.6)
50 75 (13.2) (19.8)
100 (26.4)
125 (33)
150 (39.6)
Amount Q ᐍ / min (gpm/min) RKP04162
10-105
BLADE SAFETY VALVE
a
b
A
A
SectionAA-A Sezione -A
c
d
RKP04140
SPECIFICATIONS Start opening: 24 (348) 20 (290) 16 (232)
C2 ➔ V2
12 (174) 8 (116) 4 (58) 0 0
10-106
8 bar (116 psi)
C2 ➔ V2
V2 Port - From swivel joint (5a Port) V1 Port - From swivel joint (3a Port) C2 Port - To blade cylinder (Bottom side) C1 Port - To blade cylinder (Head side)
Differential pressure ⌬p bar (PSI)
a. b. c. d.
12 (3.2)
24 (6.3)
36 (9.5)
48 60 (12.7) (15.9) Amount Q ᐍ / min (gpm/min) RKP04062
PC75R-2
2-PIECE BOOM SAFETY VALVE
a
b A
A
1
1
2
3
3
2
Section A-A Sezione A -A
c
d
RKP04070
C1 Port - To 2-piece boom (Head side) C2 Port - To 2-piece boom (Bottom side) V1 Port - From control valve (A10 Port) V2 Port - From control valve (B10 Port)
24 (348) 20 (290) C2 ➔ V2
a. b. c. d.
SPECIFICATIONS Pilot ratio: 4.25 : 1
Differential pressure ⌬p bar (PSI)
1. Screw 2. Plug 3. Valve
16 (232)
C2 ➔ V2
12 (174) 8 (116) 4 (58) 0 0
12 (3.2)
24 (6.3)
36 (9.5)
48 60 (12.7) (15.9) Amount Q ᐍ / min (gpm/min) RKP08681
PC75R-2
10-107
OVERLOAD SENSOR SWITCH
1 2
3
4
5
3 1
2
RKP11580
a. From boom safety valve (M Port) 1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
Connector Pressure sensor switch Adjusting screw Cover Connection plate
10-108
TECHNICAL DATA Setting valve: 130 bar (1885.4 psi) FUNCTION The overload sensor switch is connected through the boom safety valve to boom cylinder (bottom side). When the pressure rises over the setting valve, the sensor close the electrical circuit and the actives the horn.
PC75R-2
SOLENOID VALVE Solenoid valve group ST1
Swing brake, travel speed acceleration, working mode, servocontrol
1
2
3
4
a
f
b
e
d
c RKP11570
a. P Port b. c. d. e. F.
B2 A4 A3 A1 T
Port Port Port Port Port
PC75R-2
- From servocontrol feed unit (PR Port) - To swivel joint (2 Port) - To hydraulic tank - To hydraulic pump (PM Port) - To swing motor (B Port) - To hydraulic tank
1. 2. 3. 4.
Y6 Travel speed acceleration Y5 Swing brake Y11 Working mode Y12 Servocontrol
10-109
Solenoid valve group OP1 (Y3-Y4) Braker, rotating and cutting bucket
a
b
1
2
d
c
RKP03940
1. Y4 - R.H. attachment control 2. Y3 - L.H. attachment control a. T Port - To hydraulic tank b. A Port - To control valve (PB9 Port) c. P Port - From ST1 solenoid valve group (A4 Port) d. B Port - To control valve (PA9 Port)
10-110
PC75R-2
ELECTRICAL DIAGRAM (1/3) 1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
A2.5
11
12
13
14
A2.5
BR
R2
1
C
2
17
18
19
20
F7
7.5A
7.5A
F9 7.5A
F14
F8
10A
5A
STRUMENTO MULTIFUNZIONE MULTIFUNCTION INSTRUMENT
HA1
X13 X13 X13 X13 X13 X13 X13 X13 X13 X13 X13 X13 X13 X13 X13 X13 9
10
11
12
V1
13
14
15
BUZZER
H-L1
8
16
H-N1
7
S1
6
B-N1
5
G1
4
R-V1
3
3
V-B1
Z-B1
X15
2
A-G1
1
H-R1
H-R1
S1
A-R1
B
L1
R-N1.5
M-V1
G4
ST
B-R1
X10 X10
OFF ACC
L1.5
R1
F13
ACC
16
A2.5 2.1
R1
15
X14
1
G1
G1
3.1
8
X15
H-R1
R4
R-N1
A-N1.5 L1.5 R2.5
R2.5
85
87a
X3
14
7
2
X7
X7 V1
A-G1
S1
X17
3
X16
4
H-N1
X7 X15 X7 B-N1
X15
3
15
53S 53M
9
2.1 2.1
A-N1.5
4
7
2
X3
X3
X3
X17 2
X17 X17
X17
X16
X17
7
15
6
8
3
87 M-V1
Z-B1
Z-B1
B-R1
Z-N1
86
L/R1
L-R1
R-V1
KT1
G4
1
B-R1
R4
R2.5
X17 16 RLY
X3
X30
3
3.1
31
X3
1
11
3.1
A/V1
X3
21
L/R1
B-R1
6
X15 X8
L/R1
X7
2
4
V-B1
L/R1 1
L/R1
X7
9
2
X1
X8
R-V1
X7
L/R1
6
M-V1
G4 5
8
9
L/R1
L/R1
R-N1
X1
2
X3
30
X7
X8
Z-N1
1
X30
85
1
X9
Z-B1
87
5
X3
86
3
R4
1
8
X7
RL1
X8
B-R1
X9
B-R1
R-N1
2.1
30
M-N1 R6 R4
60A 86
R2
86
30
85
87
86
30
85
S-G1
S-G1
M-V1
M-V1
A/V1
V1
H-N1
S1
B-N1
Z-B1
50
R4
W
M
12Vcc
1
X18
A-N1.5
G2 30
2
XAM XAM
B-R1
M1
3
A-G1
M6
XA
XA
R50
G1
30
R4
R10
G4
A2.5
87
V-B1
30A
87
R2.5
40A
85
R-N1.5
50A
R3
R1
FUG2 FUG3 FUG1 FUG4
30
G
D+
Y1
Y11
3
S2
S5
p
p
R6
R7
S6
S7
Y5
p
t
S8
S9
p
p
S10
Y12
UU
N1.5
N1
A-R1 N1
N1
N1
N1
N1
N1
3
N1
X18 N1
N2.5
N1
N50
XAM 1
A-R1
t 31
31
P
2.1
RKP07280
COMPONENTS
PC75R-2
G1 G2 HA1 M1 R4 R6 R7
-
RL1 RLY S1 S2
-
Battery Generator Buzzer Starter motor Heating start Fuel level sender Engine water temperature sender Horn relay Rotation timer Starting switch Brakes pressure switch
S5 S6
- Air filter blocked switch - Engine water high temperature switch S7 - Engine oil low pressure switch S8 - 2nd rotation pressure switch S9 - 1st rotation pressure switch S10 - Arm micro switch Y1 - Fuel shut off solenoid valve Y5 - Rotation brake solenoid valve Y11 - Solenoid valve mode system Y12 - Servocontrol solenoid valve
FUSES F7 - /5 sec. Timer fuse 7.5A F8 - Multifunction instrument power fuse 5A F9 - Horn fuse 7.5A FUG1- Fuel shut off fuse 30A FUG2- General fuse 50A FUG3- Preheating fuse 40A FUG4- Generator fuse 60A F13 - Fuel shut off fuse 7.5A F14 - Servocontrol valve fuse 10A
CONNECTOR X1 - Power 3 way connector X3 - Engine line 9 way connector X7 - Right lateral dashboard line 9 way connector X8 - Central unit line 4 way connector X9 - Power 3 way connector X10 - Power (+15) 2 way connector X13 - Multifunction instrument 16 way connector X14 - 1 way connector X15 - Right lateral dashboard 21 way connector
X16 - Left front light 11 way connector X17 - Valves and right front light line 17 way connector X18 - Fuel level sender 3 way connector X30 - 2 way connector XA - Generator 2 way connector XAM - Fuel shut off 3 way connector
10-111
PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
10-112
PC75R-2
ELECTRICAL DIAGRAM (2/3) 3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
15
16
17
18
13
14
15
16
17
S12
S13
18
3.1
X12 X12 X12 X12 X12 X12 X12 X12 X12 X12 X12 X12 1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
S-N1
12
R/N1
11
G-R1
10
R-V1
9
A-V1
8
Z-N1
7
V-N1
6
20
PULSANTIERA PRINCIPALE SWITCHES PANEL
L/R1
5
L-B1
4
M-N1
3
R-N1
2
H-R1
R/N1
1
19 A2.5
S11
X11 X11 X11 X11 X11 X11 X11 X11 X11 X11 X11 X11 X11 X11 X11 X11 X11 X11
H-R1 R-N1 L/R1
Y3
6
20
X15
X15
X17
X17
X16
X17
1
11
5
4
4
Y4
1
1
X28
X19 S14
Y7
S15
A-V1
S16
X17 1
S-N1
A-V1
V-N1
S-N1
7
X15
X16
M-N1
Z-N1
2
5
X15
V-N1
X16
10
X15
M/N1
2
X15
L-B1
1
X15
Z-N1
X15
L-B1
4
M-N1
1.20
14
MANIPOLATORE PPC VALVE
PULSANTIERA PRINCIPALE SWITCHES PANEL
10A
1.20
13
A2.5
A2.5
F10
1.20
12
M/N1
1.10
2
M/N1
1
Y6
p
X28
X19
1.20
N1
N1
N1
N1
3
N1
N1
N1
N1
N1
2
3.1
RKP07290
COMPONENTS S11 - Joystick horn button S12 - Joystick grab button S13 - Joystick hammer button S14 - Anti overturning pressure switch S15 - Hammer pedal button S16 - Pliers button Y3 - Biting grab solenoid valve Y4 - Hammer solenoid valve Y6 - Acceleration solenoid valve Y7 - Optional pliers solenoid valve
PC75R-2
CONNECTOR X11 - Switches panel 18 way connector X12 - Switches panel 12 way connector X15 - Right lateral dashboard 21 way connector X16 - Left front light line 11 way connector X17 - Valves and right front light line 17 way connector X19 - Anti overturning pressure switch 4 way connector X28 - Optional pliers solenoid valve 2 way connector
FUSE F10 - Switch panel relays fuse 10A
10-113
PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
10-114
PC75R-2
ELECTRICAL DIAGRAM (3/3) 1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
A2.5
A2.5
R2.5
R2.5
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
2.20 1.20
G1
G1 1.20
G1 B 1
0
C
F5
E
7.5A
2
A
S3
F6 15A
B 1
0
C
F4
E
7.5A
2
A
F
15/1
1
0
49/4
F
30/3
L/6
30b/2
R/7
F3
F11
7.5A
7.5A
F12 15A
S17
L1.5
12
X15
X15
2
1
3
57
56b L
56a
57
56b L
56a
H2
H2.5
B/R1
R1
B-R1.5
G1.5
V1.5 4
X21
6
M
5
X21
X20
X17
3
2
13
1
C1
B-G1
2
3
1
2
1
1
X21
X21
X21
X26
X26
X27
H6
X1 M
X20
B/R1
6
H2.5
X17 5
X21
H4 H5
H3
X16
1
R1
H1.5 2
X25 X25 X25
X24
X23
X20
4
A-R1.5
G-N1.5
M1.5
2
2
X23
X20
9
B-R1.5
X16 10
G1.5
X16
X17
M2 H1
V1.5
A-R1.5
C-V1.5
R1.5
V2 12
1
X22
30
10
B1.5
B1.5 1
X22
87
X17 7
M1.5
9
V1
B1
M1
X17 X16 8
14
X15
G1.5
87a
85
X16
13
X15
H1.5
86
A-R1.5
RL2
C-V1.5
15A
19
X15
C-V1.5
F2
17
X15
G-N1.5
V-N1.5
F1 10A
18
X15
G1
16
X15 H-N1.5
15
R1.5
G1.5
V-N1.5
H-N1.5
C1
1.20
M3
2
M4 M
S18
M
31
31
X29 X29 AUTORADIO
X27
B-G1
2
N1
N1.5
N1.5 N1.5
N1.5 N1.5
N1.5
N1.5
RADIO
1
3
N1.5
N1
3
X24
N1
X23
N1.5
X22
2.20
COMPONENTS H1 - Front left light H2 - Front right light H3 - Working light H4 - Working light H5 - Beacon lamp H6 - Cabin lamp M2 - Blower motor M3 - Washer motor M4 - Transfer pump RL2 - Arm working light relay S17 - Rotating lamp switch
PC75R-2
S18 S3 V1 V2
-
Transfer pump sender Lights switch Diode Diode
FUSES
CONNECTOR
F1 - Low beam fuse 10A F2 - Main beam fuse15A F3 - Cabin lamp, radio and current intake fuse 7.5A F4 - Rotating lamp fuse 7.5A F5 - Working light fuse 7.5A F6 - Heater fuse 15A F11 - Cabin power fuse 7.5A F12 - Transfer pump fuse 15A
X1 - Power 3 way connector X15 - Right lateral dashboard 21 way connector X16 - Left front light line 11 way connector X17 - Valves and right front light line 17 way connector X20 - Left front light line 5 way connector X21 - Cabin 7 way connector
RKP07260
X22 X23 X25 X26 X27
-
Left front light 3 way connector Right front light 3 way connector Left front light line 4 way connector Transfer pump 2 way connector Transfer pump sender 4 way connector X29 - Radio power 2 way connector
10-115
10-116
PC75R-2
GROUP
20
40-28
PC15R-8
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
Normal or standard technical data . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 2 Equipment for testing, adjusting, and identifying faults. . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 19 Measuring the engine speed.. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 21 Adjusting valve clearance . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 22 Measuring compression pressure .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 23 Testing and adjusting fuel injection timing . .. . . . .. . 24 Testing and adjusting fan belt tension .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 26 Adjusting the stroke of the accelerator lever . . . . .. . 27 Adjusting ppc valves clearance. . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 28 Adjusting the safety microswitch . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 29 Measuring the swing circle axial clearance. .. . . . .. . 30 Testing and adjusting track-shoe tension . . . .. . . . .. . 31 Air bleeding from hydraulic circuits . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 32 Releasing residual pressure from the circuits . . . .. . 35 Checking and regulating pressure in the hydraulic circuits . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 36 Testing and setting of main valves . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 37
Adjusting PC valve . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 39 Measuring LS differential pressure and adjusting LS valve . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 40 Checking and adjusting pressures in the servocontrol feed unit .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 42 Measuring pumps delivery and flow control starting point pump P1 . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 43 Measuring travel deviation .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 45 Adjusting the maximum speed of the travel motors46 Measuring inner oil leakage of travel motor . . . .. . . . 47 Adjusting boom and arm safety valves. . . . .. . . . .. . . . 48 Adjusting 2nd boom safety valves. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 49 Measuring and setting of pressure switch signal overload operation . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 50 Measurement of internal oil leakages in the swing motor . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 51 Checking for leakages inside the swivel joint. . .. . . . 52 Analysis of the causes of hydraulic drifts . .. . . . .. . . . 54
When carrying out controls, adjustments or analyses for troubleshooting, park the machine on firm, level ground. Apply all the machine safety devices and use blocks to prevent any machine movement. When more than one person is engaged in the work, use the prescribed notices that indicate that the machine is undergoing maintenance. Do not allow any unauthorised persons to remain in the vicinity. When checking the level of the cooling liquid, wait until this liquid has cooled. If the radiator cap is removed while the liquid is still hot and under pressure, it may cause severe burns. Take great care not to get entangled in moving parts (fan, alternator belt or any of the rotating elements).
PC75R-2
20-1
NORMAL OR STANDARD TECHNICAL DATA . FOR ENGINE
Machine model
PC75R-2
Engine
4D98E-1FB
Check item
Test Conditions
Unit
Standard value
Permissible value
Engine speed
High idling Low idling Set speed
rpm rpm rpm
2470 1000 2300
2470w50 1000 50 Ð
Exhaust gas colour
Sudden acceleration At high idling speed
Index Bosch
0.9 0.5
1.5 0.8
Valve clearance
Intake valve (20ëC) (68ëF) Exhaust valve (20ëC) (68ëF)
mm (in.) mm (in.)
0.20 (0.0078) 0.20 (0.0078)
Ð Ð
Compression pressure (SAE30 oil)
Oil temperature 69 ± 72ëC (156.2 ±161.6ëF)
kg/cm2 (psi) rpm
35w1 (497.7w14.2) 250
28w1 (398.2w14.2) 250
Blow-by pressure (SAE30 oil)
Water temperature in operating range At high idling speed
mm H2O
Ð
Ð
kg/cm2 (psi)
max. 6 (max. 85.32)
Ð
kg/cm2 (psi) kg/cm2 (psi)
3±4 (42.66 ± 56.88) min. 0.6 (min. 8.532)
Ð Ð
ëC (ëF)
120 (248)
Max. 120 (Max. 248)
degrees
10 ± 12
Ð
mm (in.)
10 ± 15 (0.394 ± 0.591)
Ð
(Engine speed)
Max. idling (in cold state) Engine oil pressure
With water temperature in operating range High idling At low idling
Oil temperature
Entire speed range
Fuel injection timing
B.T.D.C.
Fan-belt tension
Deflection when pressed with finger force of approx. 10 kg (22 lb.)
20-2
PC75R-2
. FOR MACHINE All tests, if not otherwise specified, should be performed with WORKING MODE in position P Machine model Classification
Check item
Engine
Engine speed with pump P1 at max. pressure Engine speed with pumps P1 and P2 at max. pressure Engine speed with pump P2 at max. pressure Engine speed when pumps P1-P2 are at max. pressure and the WORKING MODE selector is in pos. E
PC75R-2
Test conditions
. . . . . . .
Unit
Hydraulic oil temp.: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Engine oil pressure: in correct range Cooling water temp.: in correct range Swing lock pin inserted Max. pressure P1: with boom Max. pressure P1-P2: with boom and swing boom Max. pressure P2: with arm and swing boom
Permissible value
2296
2296 ± 50
2285
2285 ± 50
2300
2300 ± 50
2250
2250 ± 50
rpm
,
Boom control valve
a
b
,
a
b
ᐉ
Arm control valve Spool travel
Standard value
a
Bucket control valve
b
Swing control valve
mm (in.)
Blade control valve Boom swing control valve 2nd boom control valve
6.5w0.3 45 6.5w0.3 45 6.5w0.3 6.5w0.3 (0.256w (1.773) (0.256w (0.256w (1.773) (0.256w 0.0118) 0.0118) 0.0118) 0.0118)
RKP08070
Right travel control valve .
At centre of Neutral lever knob Reading at end of travel Neutral Engine stopped Neutral Equipment on the ground
Raise Lower
80 (3.152)
60 ± 100 (2.364 ± 3.94)
Extended Retracted
80 (3.152)
60 ± 100 (2.364 ± 3.94)
Open Curled
80 (3.152)
60 ± 100 (2.364 ± 3.94)
Neutral
Swing right Swing left
80 (3.152)
60 ± 100 (2.364 ± 3.94)
Blade control lever
Neutral
Raise Lower
50 (1.97)
38 ± 62 (1.497 ± 2.443)
Boom swing pedal
Neutral
Swing right Swing left
20 (0.788)
15 ± 25 (0.591 ± 0.985)
2nd boom pedal
Neutral
Open Closed
30 (1.182)
25 ± 35 (0.985 ± 1.379)
Travel control pedal (right-left)
Neutral
Forward Backward
120 (4.728)
90 ± 150 (3.546 ± 5.910)
Fuel control lever
Min.
150 (5.910)
130 ± 170 (5.122 ± 6.698)
Boom control lever
. Arm control lever
Travel of levers and pedals
Bucket control lever Swing control lever
PC75R-2
. .
Max.
mm (in.)
20-3
. FOR MACHINE Machine model Classification
Standard value
Permissible value
2.0 (4.4)
1.5 ± 2.5 (3.3 ±5.5)
2.0 (4.4)
1.5 ± 2.5 (3.3 ±5.5)
1.5 (3.3)
1.1 ± 1.9 (2.4 ± 4.2)
Arm open-close
2.0 (4.4)
1.5 ± 2.5 (3.3 ±5.5)
Swing (R.H.-L.H.)
1.5 (3.3)
1.1 ± 1.9 (2.4 ± 4.2)
Blade
2.0 (4.4)
1.5 ± 2.5 (3.3 ±5.5)
10 (22)
7.5 ± 12.5 (16.5 ± 27.5)
10 (22)
7.5 ± 12.5 (16.5 ± 27.5)
Lever (centre)
2.5 (5.5)
1.9 ± 3.1 (4.2 ± 6.8)
Pedal
9.0 (19.8)
8 ± 10 (17.6 ± 22)
Travel accelerator control pedal
9.0 (19.8)
8 ± 10 (17.6 ± 22)
Fuel control levers
3.0 (6.6)
2.5 ± 3.5 (5.5 ± 7.6)
Check item
Operating force for control of levers and pedals
Raise boom
Main valve pressure
PC75R-2
Test conditions
Lower boom
. . .
Bucket curled-open
.
Unit
Engine speed: high idling Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Instrument coupling at centre of control lever knob Instrument coupling on outside edge of pedal control
kg (lb.)
Boom swing pedal 2nd boom pedal
Travel control lever (R.H.-L.H.)
300 (4351)
7 (101.5)
300 (4351)
7 (101.5)
30/50 (435.1/725)
w3 (43.5)
Raise
270 (3916)
7 (101.5)
Lower
270 (3916)
7 (101.5)
270 (3916)
7 (101.5)
270 (3916)
7 (101.5)
210 (3046)
7 (101.5)
210 (3046)
7 (101.5)
270 (3916)
7 (101.5)
270 (3916)
7 (101.5)
Travel
270 (3916)
7 (101.5)
Attachments
270 (3916)
7 (101.5)
Servocontrols
30 (435.1)
w3 (43.5)
25 ± 39 (362.6 ± 565.6)
Ð
21w1 (304.6w14.5)
Ð
P1 pump (Safety) P2 pump (Safety) Servocontrols (Safety)
. . .
Boom Arm Bucket
. . .
Engine speed: max. Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Check one circuit at a time
bar (psi)
Engine speed: max. Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Check one circuit at a time
Hydraulic pressure
Swing bar (psi)
Blade Boom swing 2
nd
boom
. LS differential pressure
.
. Engine: high idling Oil temperature: . . 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) .
20-4
Levers at NEUTRAL Travel speed: Hi Travel lever: at the end of stroke Track shoe: raised
bar (psi)
PC75R-2
. FOR MACHINE Machine model Classification
Check item
PC75R-2
Test conditions
Unit
Standard value
Permissible value
Degree (mm)
Max. 60ë (400)
90ë (600)
Ð
Ð
Max. 5
Max. 5.5
sec
33
31 ± 35
mm (in.)
0 (0)
Ð
Work equipment at max. reach
Braking angle
RKP05770
. . . .
Load in the bucket: 475 kg (1047 lb.) Engine speed: high idling. Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Make centring marks on the outer swing circle rings. Rotate the upper turret 360ë and stop. Measure the difference between the marks after stopping.
Working equipment at max. reach 90ë sec
Time taken to start swing
RKP05770
. .
Swing
.
Engine speed: high idling Oil temperature: 180ë 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Time taken also from starting position to swing 90ë and 180ë.
Working equipment at max. reach
Time taken to swing
RKP05770
. . . .
Engine speed: high idling Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Make one turn to settle machine. Measure the time taken to make 5 full swings
15° RKP05780
Hydraulic drift of swing
. . . . . .
PC75R-2
Engine stopped Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Brake disengaged (with specific tool) Park the machine on a 15ë slope and set the boom at 90ë with respect to the ground surface On the outer swing circle, mark the position between turret and track frame. After 15 minutes measure the drift.
20-5
. FOR MACHINE Machine model Classification
Check item
PC75R-2
Test conditions
Unit
Standard value
Permissible value
mm (in.)
0 (0)
0 (0)
,/min
0.70 (0.185)
Max. 1.5 (Max. 0.396)
Swing
15°
Hydraulic drift of swing
RKP05780
. . . .
Swing
.
20-6
. Internal leakage from swing . motor . .
Engine stopped Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Park the machine on a 15ë slope and set the boom at 90ë with respect to the ground surface On the outer swing circle, mark the position between turret and track frame. After 15 minutes measure the drift.
Engine speed: high idling Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Swing block: engaged Measure the leakage
(US.gpm)
PC75R-2
. FOR MACHINE
Check item
Standard value
Permissible value
20
Min. 17
High speed
Classification
PC75R-2
32
Min. 28
Low speed
Machine model
24
Max. 27 Min. 21
14
Max. 16 Min. 12
200 (7.874)
Max. 250 (Max. 9.843)
Test conditions
Unit
Low speed
Measuring posture
Travel motor swing speed (1) (no-load)
rpm RKP05790
. . .
Engine speed: high idling Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Rest the bucket on the ground, raise one track-shoe and mark a position on the reduction unit. Measure the rotating speed of the sprocket wheel. Repeat for the 2nd track-shoe
Measuring posture
sec
Travel speed (2) RKP05800
. . . .
Engine speed: high idling Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) On flat ground Travel for at least 10 metres and then check on the time needed to cover 20 metres
High speed
Travel
45°
45°
RKP05800
Travel deviation
. .
Engine speed: high idling Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) . Travel 20 metres on flat ground and measure the deviation. H The surface must be hard and horizontal.
mm (in.)
20m
X 10m
H
PC75R-2
RKP05810
Measure dimension «X»
20-7
. FOR MACHINE Machine model Classification
Check item
PC75R-2
Test conditions
Unit
Standard value
Permissible value
mm (in.)
0 (0)
0 (0)
,/min (US.gpm)
13 (3.43)
Max. 25 (Max. 6.6)
Measuring posture
15°
Travel
Hydraulic drift of travel motors
RKP05820
. . . .
Leakage of travel motors
. . .
H
20-8
Engine: switched off Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Stop machine on a slope with blade raised and sprocket facing straight up the slope Measure the drift after 5 minutes Engine speed: high idling Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Lock shoes and check leakage Measure one motor at a time
PC75R-2
. FOR MACHINE Machine model Classification
Check item
PC75R-2 Standard value
Permissible value
400 (15.748)
500 (19.685)
Boom
400 (15.748)
500 (19.685)
Boom
75 (2.953)
90 (3.543)
80 (3.150)
100 (3.937)
50 (1.968)
60 (2.362)
60 (2.362)
75 (2.953)
30 (1.181)
40 (1.575)
Boom
600 (23.622)
800 (31.496)
Boom
600 (23.622)
800 (31.496)
Boom
80 (3.150)
100 (3.937)
Boom
90 (3.543)
115 (4.528)
60 (2.362)
75 (2.953)
75 (2.953)
100 (3.937)
Boom
50 (1.968)
60 (2.362)
Boom
60 (2.362)
75 (2.953)
30 (1.181)
40 (1.575)
Test conditions
Unit
Measuring posture Boom
Total work equipment (Standard boom) (Downward movement bucket teeth tips)
A
A B
B
RKP05831
Boom cylinder (Retraction)
Hydraulic drift of working equipment
Arm cylinder (Extension)
.
. . . . . . .
Bucket cylinder (Retraction)
Total work equipment (Downward movement of tips of bucket teeth) (2-piece boom)
.
A In this position, measure extension or retraction of each cylinder, and any leakages occurring when a Boom load is applied to the tips of the B bucket teeth. Horizontal levelled ground Bucket: rated load 475 kg (1047 lb.) Boom A Levers: neutral Engine: switched off Boom Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) B Safety valve disengaged Take measurements as soon as the engine stops Measure the variations every 5 minutes and check the total variation after 15 mins.
Measuring posture
A
B
A B
Boom cylinder (Retraction)
2nd boom cylinders (Retraction)
Arm cylinder (Extension)
A
RKP05841
.
. . . . . . . .
Bucket cylinder (Retraction)
PC75R-2
mm (in.)
In this position, measure extension and retraction of each cylinder, and any leakages when a load is applied to the tips of the bucket teeth. Horizontal levelled ground Bucket: rated load 475 kg (1047 lb.) Levers: neutral Engine: switched off Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Safety valve disengaged Take measurements as soon as the engine stops Measure the variations every 5 minutes and check the total variation after 15 mins.
B
Boom
A
Boom
B A
B
mm (in.)
20-9
. FOR MACHINE Machine model Classification
PC75R-2 Standard value
Permissible value
Boom
30 (1.181)
35 (1.378)
Boom
35 (1.378)
40 (1.575)
Boom
40 (1.575)
45 (1.772)
Boom
45 (1.772)
50 (1.969)
6 (0.236)
10 (0.394)
Max. 3.5
Max. 12
Max. 2.2 (each cylinder)
Max. 8
Max. 2.2
Max. 8
Max. 2.2
Max. 8
Boom swing
Max. 2.5
Max. 10
Blade
Max. 3.5
Max. 12
Check item
Test conditions
Unit
A
Boom swing (Standard boom) 15°
B
Hydraulic drift of working equipment
RKP05850
. . Boom swing (boom and 2-piece boom)
.
Blade (measure the downward movement of the edge of the blade)
Engine: switched off Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) In the same position as above, park the machine on a 15ë slope and bring the turret round to 90ë. Measure the extension and retraction of the cylinder after 15 mins.
mm (in.) A
B
RKP05870
. . . .
mm (in.)
Engine: switched off Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Safety valve disengaged Raise the blade and measure the height of the edge from the ground. Measure the downward after 15 mins.
Internal cylinder leankage
Boom 2nd boom (2 cylinders) Arm Bucket
20-10
. . . H H
Engine speed: high idling Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Check leakages: on the cylinder on the side opposite to the one under pressure Check one cylinder at a time For the 2-piece boom check the two cylinders individually but simultaneously.
cc/ min
PC75R-2
. FOR MACHINE
Raise Lower
Speed
Work equipment
Closed
Measuring posture
RKP05890
.
Measuring posture
Cylinder completely retracted
RKP05900
. .
Engine speed: high idling Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF)
.
Measuring posture
Cylinder completely retracted
RKP05910
Cylinders completely extended
. .
Engine speed: high idling Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF)
Boom swing
.
Measuring posture
Cylinder completely retracted
RKP05920
. .
Engine speed: high idling Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF)
.
Measuring posture
Blade on the ground
PC75R-2
Inout
.
Arm
Blade raised to max. height
1.9 ± 2.3
2.5
2.2 ± 2.8
Closed
Engine speed: high idling Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF)
Engine speed: high idling Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF)
Blade
2.1
3.5
3.1 ± 3.9
Inout
RKP05880
. .
. .
Cylinders completely extended
2.2 ± 2.8
2.6
2.3 ± 2.9
3.0
2.7 ± 3.3
2.2
1.9 ± 2.5
6.0
5.4 ± 6.6
6.0
5.4 ± 6.6
1.3
1.1 ± 1.5
. .
1.4
1.2 ± 1.6
Unit
Measuring posture
Cylinders completely extended
Bucket
2.5
Curled
.
Cylinders completely retracted
Cylinders completely extended
1.9 ± 2.3
Dump
2nd boom
2.1
Test conditions
Bucket teeth on the ground
Cylinder completely extended
Permissible value
L.H.
Boom
Standard value
R.H.
Check item
Raise
Classification
PC75R-2
Lower
Machine model
RKP05930
Engine speed: high idling Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF)
sec
20-11
. FOR MACHINE Machine model Classification
Check item
PC75R-2
Test conditions
Unit
Standard value
Permissible value
Max. 2
Max. 3
Max. 2
Max. 3
Max. 2
Max. 3
Measuring posture
Boom (Standard) RKP05940
. . .
Engine speed: low idling Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Retract fully the cylinders of the arm and bucket. Lower bucket to ground and measure time taken for chassis to rise from ground.
Time lags
Work equipment
Measuring posture
Boom (2-piece boom)
sec RKP05950
. . .
Engine speed: low idling Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Retract fully the cylinders of the arm and bucket. Extend the 2nd boom fully. Lower bucket to ground and measure time taken for chassis to rise from ground.
Measuring posture
2nd boom RKP05960
. . . .
20-12
Engine speed: low idling Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) 0 0 Check valve: 60+ 5 bar (852.2+ 71 psi) Retract fully the cylinders of the arm and bucket. Extend the 2nd boom fully. Bring the boom into a vertical position. Close completely the 2nd boom and measure the time taken increase the pressure.
PC75R-2
. FOR MACHINE Machine model Classification
Check item
PC75R-2
Test conditions
Unit
Standard value
Permissible value
Max. 2
Max. 3
Max. 2
Max. 3
Max. 2
Max. 3
Max. 1
Max. 2
Measuring posture
Boom
A
RKP05970
Arm . . .
Engine speed: low idling Boom Oil temperature: B 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Bring the boom into a horizontal position. Retract the cylinder of the arm completely and then extend it. Amount of time when arm stops for a moment.
Time lags
Work equipment
Measuring posture
RKP05980
Bucket . . .
sec
Engine speed: low idling Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Bring the boom into a horizontal position. Retract the bucket cylinder completely, then extend it. Measure the time that elapses between the bucket stopping at dead centre and then starting to move again.
Measuring posture
Blade
RKP05990
. . .
PC75R-2
Engine speed: low idling Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Raise the blade to its max. height, then lower it. Measure the time it takes for the rear of the machine to be lifted off the ground, starting from the time the blade contacts the ground.
20-13
. FOR MACHINE Machine model Check item
Pump delivery
Pumps
Classification
Piston pumps P1
20-14
Test conditions
. Gear pump P2
PC75R-2
. .
Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) Measure with engine at rated speed At relief valve set pressure (29.4 bar (417.6 psi)
Unit
Standard value
Permissible value
,/min
64.4 (17.013)
Min. 58 (Min. 15.322)
(US.gpm)
See following pages
PC75R-2
Machine model
Pump torque (kgm) (lb.ft.)
Delivery of individual piston pumps P1 WORKING MODE selector: position P Pump speed: 2300 rpm. Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF)
Q (ᐍ/min) (gpm)
Classifi- . cation . . .
PC75R-2
200 (52.8) 144.6 bar (2097.1 psi) 174.8 ᐉ/min (46.18 gpm)
178 (47)
25 (180.8)
170 (44.9)
150 (39.6)
137.2 bar (1989.8 psi) 161.2 ᐉ/min (42.59 gpm)
21.4 (154.8) 20 (144.6)
172.8 bar (2506.1 psi) 173.5 ᐉ/min (36.3 gpm)
Pump characteristics
Maximum delivery
264.6 bar (3721.5 psi) 88.3 ᐉ/min (23.3 gpm)
172.8 bar (2506.1 psi) 117 ᐉ/min (30.9 gpm)
100 (26.4)
15 (108.5)
10 (72.3) Minimum delivery 5 (36.2)
264.6 bar (3721.5 psi) 65.2 ᐉ/min (17.2 gpm)
50 (13.2)
0
Gear pump P2 pressure: 19.8 bar (284.4 psi)
0 49 (711)
98 (1422)
147 (2133)
196 (2844)
294 245 265 (3555) (3839) (4266)
P(bar) (psi) RKP08062
H When measuring the deliveries with the pumps mounted on the machine, it becomes difficult to use the accelerator to set the number of engine rpm corresponding to the test speed prescribed for the pump. Measure the delivery with the engine set to 2300 rpm, and perform a proportional calculation to find the delivery value required for the test.
PC75R-2
20-15
Machine model
Pump torque (kgm) (lb.ft.)
Delivery of individual piston pumps P1 WORKING MODE selector: position E Pump speed: 2300 rpm. Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF)
Q (ᐍ/min) (gpm)
Classifi- . cation . . .
PC75R-2
200 (52.8)
78.2 bar (1134.1 psi) 174.8 ᐉ/min (46.18 gpm)
178 (47) 170 (44.9)
25 (180.8)
62.2 bar (902.1 psi) 165.1 ᐉ/min (43.62 gpm)
104.8 bar (1519.9 psi) 138.7 ᐉ/min (36.64 gpm)
150 (39.6)
20 (144.6)
16.2 (117.1) 15 (108.5)
Pump characteristics
Maximum delivery 10 (72.3)
100 (26.4) 99.9 bar (1448.8 psi) 118.7 ᐉ/min (31.36 gpm) 264.6 bar (3721.5 psi) 57 ᐉ/min (5.68 gpm)
Minimum delivery
50 (13.2)
5 (36.2)
0
264.6 bar (3721.5 psi) 28.4 ᐉ/min (7.5 gpm)
Gear pump P2 pressure: 19.8 bar (284.4 psi)
0 49 (711)
98 (1422)
147 (2133)
196 (2844)
294 245 265 (3555) (3839) (4266)
P(bar) (psi) RKP08051
H When measuring the deliveries with the pumps mounted on the machine, it becomes difficult to use the accelerator to set the number of engine rpm corresponding to the test speed prescribed for the pump. Measure the delivery with the engine set to 2300 rpm, and perform a proportional calculation to find the delivery value required for the test.
20-16
PC75R-2
Machine model
Pump torque (kgm) (lb.ft.)
Delivery of individual piston pumps P1 with swing acting WORKING MODE selector: position P Pump speed: 2300 rpm. Oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF)
Q (ᐍ/min) (gpm)
Classifi- . cation . . .
PC75R-2
200 (52.8)
5.8 bar (84.1 psi) 174.8 ᐉ/min (46.2 gpm)
25 (180.8)
170 (44.9) 155,7 (41.1)
30.3 bar (439.7 psi) 141.2 ᐉ/min (37.3 gpm)
21,3 (154.1) 20 (144.6)
150 (39.6)
Pump characteristics
15 (108.5)
100 (26.4)
10 (72.3)
Maximum delivery
25.5 bar (369.8 psi) 122.3 ᐉ/min (32.3 gpm)
5 (36.2)
Minimum delivery
50 (13.2)
0 256.6 bar (3721.5 psi) 21.5 ᐉ/min (5.68 gpm)
264.4 bar (3839 psi) 21 ᐉ/min (5.54 gpm)
Gear pump P2 pressure: 215,6 bar (3126.8 psi)
264.4 bar (3839 psi) 4.6 ᐉ/min (1,21 gpm)
0 49 (711)
98 (1422)
147 (2133)
196 (2844)
294 245 265 (3555) (3839) (4266)
P(bar) (psi) RKP08041
H When measuring the deliveries with the pumps mounted on the machine, it becomes difficult to use the accelerator to set the number of engine rpm corresponding to the test speed prescribed for the pump. Measure the delivery with the engine set to 2300 rpm, and perform a proportional calculation to find the delivery value required for the test.
PC75R-2
20-17
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
20-18
PC75R-2
SPECIAL TOOLS Measurement check points
Symbol
Valve clearance
A
Compression pressure
B
Engine speed
C
Water and oil temperature
D
E Hydraulic pressure
Code
Drift Test
G
Q.ty
Remarks
Feeler gauge
1
Ð
1
Commercially available
1
ATR800090
Compression gauge
1
2
ATR800130
Adapter
1
1
Commercially available
Multi-scale tachometer
1
20 - 4000 rpm
2
ATR800060
Stroboscopic tachometer
1
6 - 30000 rpm
1
Commercially available
Digital temperature gauge
1
± 50 - 1200 ëC
1
Commercially available
Pressure gauge
2
Scale 60 bar
2
Commercially available
Pressure gauge
1
Scale 250 bar
3
Commercially available
Pressure gauge
1
Scale 400 bar
4
Commercially available
Pressure gauge
1
Scale 600 bar
Kit servocontrol Digital differential pressure
1
0±1000 bar
Flowmeter
1
Delivery 0-300 ,/min.
2
Tube union kit
1
Ð
1
Instrument for swing brake unlocking
1
Ð
2
Union kit
1
Ð
5
F
Name
1
ATR800200
Kit Yanmar TOL-97190080
Track shoe tension
H
1
21D-98-11650
Grease nipple
1
Included in the machine tool kit
Hydraulic drift of boom and arm cylinders
L
1
21D-62-15530
Flange
1
Mount with O-Ring code 21D-09-69870
PC75R-2
20-19
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
20-20
PC75R-2
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
MEASURING THE ENGINE SPEED
MEASURING THE ENGINE SPEED When measuring the speed (rpm) of the engine, do not touch heated parts and take care not to become entangled in rotating elements. H Do not start to measure engine speed until the following conditions have been met: . Engine cooling water temperature: 68 ± 80ëC (154.4 ± 176 ëF) . Hydraulic system oil temperature: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) 1 - Install and connect the tachometer C1. H If a stroboscopic tachometer C2 is used, make a distinct mark on the motor pulley to facilitate the reading.
C1
RKPA5120
2 - Start the engine and check: . Low idling without load (accelerator lever in «minimum» position). . High idling without load (accelerator lever in «maximum» position). H Low idling 1000 50 rpm H High idling 2160w50 rpm H If the minimum and maximum engine speeds without load do not fall within the correct range, check the position stops of the accelerator lever and the accelerator cable sheathing (See «ACCELERATOR LEVER ADJUSTMENT») before performing the stress tests.
RKPA5130
Engine rpm with the pumps working. H Max. speed with the P1 pump working: 2290w50 rpm H Max. speed with the P1 and P2 pumps working: 2285w50 rpm H If the efficiency is not within the permissible limits, call the Authorised Repair Shop to come and give the engine a diagnostic check.
.
PC75R-2
20-21
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
ADJUSTING VALVE CLEARANCE
ADJUSTING VALVE CLEARANCE H Adjust clearance between valves and rocker levers as follows:
1 2
Unit: mm (in.)
At cold engine
Intake valve
Exhaust valve
0.20 (0.0078)
0.20 (0.0078)
H Ignition order 1-3-4-2-1..... H Normal rotation sense: counterclockwise from flywheel view. .
Adjusting procedure
RKPB1092
1 - Remove the suction pipe (1) and the valves cover (2).
4
2 - Rotate crankshaft in normal direction as long as cylinder piston to be checked is at compression Top Dead Center (PMS). H In this position intake and exhaust valves are closed. 3 - Loose lock nut (3) and unscrew tappet (4) of about 1 turn. H Check that valve insert (5) is laying flat on valve stem and that it is not worn askew. 1 - If valve inserts (5) are damaged, replaced them with new ones. 2 - Make sure that inserts feet and lay flat on valve stem.
3
5
YES SI
RKP10490
4 - Connect A1 feeler gauge between insert and rocker lever to adjust; rotate the tappet (4) until touching A1 feeler gauge. Tight tappet (4) with lock nut (3). H After tightening the lock nut, check the clearance again.
4
NO NO
5
3 A1
5 - Adjust with same procedures second cylinder valve and repeat same operation for the other cylinders, according to the ignition order.
RKP10500
.
Cover valves installation
2
1 - Check condition of cover valves (2), gasket (6), ORings (7) and lock nuts (8); clean carefully contact surface on cylinder head.
8 7
2 - Install valves cover (2), fit O-Rings (7) and lock nuts (8). Cover lock nut: 25w3 Nm (18.4w2.2 lb.ft.)
6 RKP10510
20-22
PC75R-2
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
MEASURING COMPRESSION PRESSURE
MEASURING COMPRESSION PRESSURE When measuring the compression pressure be careful not to get caught in cooling fan, in the alternator belt or in other rotating parts.
1
H Test condition: . Engine: at operating temperature . Hydraulic oil: 55 ± 60ëC (131 ± 140ëF) . Battery: at full charge . Valve clearance: adjusted (see «ADJUSTING VALVE CLEARANCE»)
2
1 - Disconnect high pressure pipe (1). 2 - Remove nozzle holder assembly (2) of cylinder to be checked.
RKPA5140
3 - Disconnect connector (3) of fuel cut-off solenoid valve (4).
3
4 - Crank engine with starting motor.
4
RKPA5150
5 - Install B2 adapter and connect B1 pressure gauge. H Check that seal is installed in the adapter and that it is not damaged. 6 - Crank engine with starting motor and measure compression pressure. H Compression value: Normal: 35w1 kg/cm2 (497.7w14.2 psi) Minimum permissible 28w1 kg/cm2 (398.1w14.2 psi) at 250 rpm H Difference between cylinders: 2 ± 3 kg/cm2 (28.4 ± 42.6 psi)
B1
(psi)
RKPA5160
Compression pressure (kg/cm2)
7 - After measuring, install the nozzle holder assembly (2), connect high pressure pipe, feedback pipe and connector (3). Nozzle holder collar bolts: 6.9 ± 8.8 Nm (5.1 ± 6.5 lb.ft.) High pressure union: 19.6 ± 24.5 Nm (14.4 ± 18 lb.ft.)
B2
40 (569) 35 (498)
30 (427) 25 (356) 20 (284) 200
250
300
350
400
Engine speed (rpm) RKP10521
PC75R-2
20-23
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
TESTING AND ADJUSTING FUEL INJECTION TIMING
TESTING AND ADJUSTING FUEL INJECTION TIMING H Check fuel injection timing of N.1 cylinder by means of N.1 delivery valve of injection pump. H Cylinders are numbered 1-2-3-4 starting from flywheel side. H On the flywheel there are marked the notches corresponding \to injection time of 0ë- 10ë - 15ë - 20ë; to note the intermediate values, divide in equal parts the sector between two notches.
CounterSenso antiorario clockwise
1
1 - Remove plug (1) from flywheel housing. Senso Clockwise orario RKPA5170
2 - Using a screwdriver putted between teeth, rotate the crankshaft in clockwise direction (from flywheel side view) until to align the mark on flywheel with mark (2) located inside the inner housing hole. H In this position, N. 1 and N. 4 cylinder pistons are both at Top Dead Centre (TDC); check that N.1 cylinder is at the end of compression stroke, with both intake and exhaust valves closed. If valves are not closed, rotate the crankshaft of 1 turn. H After recognition of TDC, rotate the crankshaft in clockwise direction (from flywheel side view) of about 25 teeth.
Mark Riferimento
2
Flywheel notch Tacca volano (PMS) (PMS)
RKPA5180
3 - Disconnect all fuel delivery pipes (3) from injection pump. 4 - Move externally the stop engine lever (4) and fix the position with a temporary string. 5 - Rotate crankshaft slowly in counterclockwise direction (from flywheel side view), checking carefully fuel level into the N. 1 delivery union of injection pump; stop the rotation as soon as fuel level starts to increase.
6 - Check the 10ë ignition timing notch position on flywheel \against the notch on housing hole. If both notches are aligned, the injection timing is of 10ë; if the notch on flywheel exceeds the notch of hole, the injection timing value is lower. H Standard fuel injection timing: 10-12ë
4 3
RKPA5190
15° 20°
10°
15° 10°
Notch Riferimento
1/4
2 RKPA5200
20-24
PC75R-2
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
TESTING AND ADJUSTING FUEL INJECTION TIMING
7 - If injection timing is not within standard value, rotate \the injection pump (5) toward external or toward engine after loosening pump nuts (6) and bolt (7) fixing the bracket to injection pump. . To RETARD injection, rotate the pump (5) toward external. . To ADVANCE injection, rotate the pump (5) toward cylinders block. 8 - Tight the pump lock nuts (6) at cylinder block and the \bolt (7) fixing injection pump to bracket (8). Nuts: 34.2 ± 44.1 Nm (25.2 ± 32.5 lb.ft.) Bracket bolt: 44.1 ± 53.9 Nm (32.5 ± 39.7 lb.ft.)
5 6
7
8
RKPA5210
9 - Connect fuel delivery pipes (3) to pump. Delivery pipe unions: 19.6 ± 24.5 Nm (14.4 ± 18 lb.ft.) 10 - Release the stop engine lever and carry out air bleeding.
PC75R-2
20-25
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
TESTING AND ADJUSTING FAN BELT TENSION
TESTING AND ADJUSTING FAN BELT TENSION 1. Tension check 1 - Push fan belt (1) at midway point between alternator (2) and pulley operating water pump; check the deflection. With a pressure of 10 kg (22 lb.)), deflection should be of 10 ± 15 mm (0.4 ± 0.6 in.); if this value is not reached, tension fan belt. H With new belt, deflection must be of 7 ± 9 mm (0.3 ± 0.35 in.).
1
2
RKPA5220
2. Fan belt tension
4
1 - Loosen mounting bolt (3) of the alternator (2) and mounting bolt (4) of adjustment plate. 2 - Rotate the alternator (2) to give correct tension to fan belt (1) and tighten mounting bolts (3) and (4). 3 - Check fan belt (1) tension. H If belt has been replaced, check tension again after about 20 operating hours.
3
Mounting bolt (3): 44.1 ± 53.9 Nm (32.5 ± 39.7 lb.ft.)
RKPB5600
Mounting bolt (4): 22.5 ± 28.4 Nm (0.88 ± 1.11 lb.ft.) Water pump Puleggia pompa pulley acqua
10kg (98 N)
10⫼15mm
Altenator Alternatore
Crankshaft Puleggia pulley albero motore RKP10530
20-26
PC75R-2
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
ADJUSTING THE STROKE OF THE ACCELERATOR LEVER
ADJUSTING THE STROKE OF THE ACCELERATOR LEVER H Test conditions: . Engine: Switched off, but at working temperature. . Low idling: within correct range. . Hydraulic oil: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) . Accelerator lever at the mid-point of its stroke.
2
1
1 - Use the stretcher (2) to eliminate clearance in the jacket (1).
RKPA5240
2 - Raise the right-hand cover in order to reach the screws (3) and (4). 3 - Unscrew the nuts (5) and (6) and tighten the screws (3) and (4) in the support. 4 - Move the accelerator lever (9) slowly towards low idling position. Stop this movement when the lever (7) on the cover of the injection pump comes into contact with the low idling adjustment screw (8).
5
9
3
9 6
4
5 - Adjust the screw (3) until it is 0.1 mm (0.004 in.)from the lever (9) and lock it in this position with the nut (5). 6 - Move the lever (9) towards the high idling position. Stop this movement when the lever (7) on the cover of the injection pump rests against the lead-sealed high idling adjustment screw (10). 7 - Adjust the screw (4) to 0.1 mm (0.004 in.) from the lever (9) and lock it in this position with the nut (6). H After adjustment, replace the right-hand cover and check that the aperture does not impede the movement of the lever (9) towards its extreme positions.
RKPA5250
10
8
7 RKPA5260
PC75R-2
20-27
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
ADJUSTING PPC VALVES CLEARANCE
ADJUSTING PPC VALVES CLEARANCE Adjust PPC valve levers clearance as follows. Rest the work equipment on the ground and stop the engine. Turn the ignition key to position «I» and move the control levers in all directions to relieve all pressure in the hydraulic circuits. Turn the ignition key to position «O» (OFF) and remove it. Put the safety device lever in its «ENGAGED» position. Slowly unscrew the filling-cap of the oil-tank to release any residual pressure.
1.
2 1
3 4
Front equipment and swing PPC valves 1 - Unscrew the retaining nut (1) of the disk (2). 2 - Screw the disk (2) down until it comes into light contact with the four plungers (3). Tighten it for another 1/8th of a turn (45ë). H During this adjustment, take care not to activate the plungers (3). 3 - Secure the position with the retaining nut, tightened to the specific torque. Retaining nut: 30w3 Nm (22.1w2.2 lb.ft.)
20-28
RKP06380
PC75R-2
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
ADJUSTING THE SAFETY MICROSWITCH
ADJUSTING THE SAFETY MICROSWITCH H Test conditions: . Engine: switched off but at working temperature. . Hydraulic oil: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF)
2
1 - Unscrew the nut (1) that secures the microswitch (2). 2 - Tighten or unscrew the microswitch (2) to the extent indicated. H Projection of microswitch: 16 1 mm (0.63 0.04 in.) 3 - Secure it in position with the nut (1).
1 RKPA5270
2
16 0+1
1
RKP07480
PC75R-2
20-29
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
MEASURING THE SWING CIRCLE AXIAL CLEARANCE
MEASURING THE SWING CIRCLE AXIAL CLEARANCE 1.
Test procedure 1 - Park the machine on firm, flat ground, revolving frame aligned with the track shoe. 2 - Extend the boom, the arm and the bucket, in such a way that they cover the maximum radius of action when the teeth of the bucket are at the same height as the lower platform of the revolving frame.
RKP10560
3 - Attach a comparator with a magnetic base (1) to the rear of the track frame (2), and so that the tracer rests below the outside ring of the swing circle (3).
3
4 - Preload the comparator by about 3 mm (0.118 in.) and set this measurement to zero.
1
2 RKPA5280
5 - Close the bucket, position the arm perpendicular to the ground and rest the back of the bucket on the ground. 6 - Push down with the boom until the front of the machine rises, transferring the weight of the track frame onto the sprocket. 7 - Check the movement of the comparator (1) in these conditions. The value read corresponds to the value of the swing circle axial clearance. H
For the standard value of the clearance, see «STANDARD MAINTENANCE».
150 -- 200 mm (5.91 -- 7.88 in.)
RKP10551
While the machine is off the ground, take care not to put hands or feet beneath the track shoes. 8 - Return the machine to phase 2 conditions and check that the comparator returns to «zero». If it does not, repeat the test, starting at phase 4.
20-30
PC75R-2
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
TESTING AND ADJUSTING TRACK-SHOE TENSION
TESTING AND ADJUSTING TRACK-SHOE TENSION 1.
Test H Test conditions: . Firm, flat ground. . Work equipment resting on the ground. 1 - Swing the turret 90ë to the side of the track to be tested.
100 -- 150 mm (3.94 -- 5.91 in.)
2 - Close the bucket, position the arm perpendicular to the ground and rest the bucket on the ground. 3 - Push down with the boom until the track-shoe to be tested has been raised completely from the ground.
RKP10541
4 - Measure the distance between the track-shoe race and the central track rollers. H Measure «A» between track roller and trackshoe: 20 ± 25 mm (0.79 ± 0.98 in.)
"A"
RKPA5290
2.
Adjustment If track-shoe tension is not within permissible limits, adjust them as follows. H Before introducing the grease-pump (2), and on completion of the adjustment, thoroughly clean the grease nipple and the surrounding area. 1 - If the tension is too slack. Inject grease through the grease nipple (1), using the grease nipple H1. H If the grease proves difficult to inject, slowly move the machine backwards and forwards over a short stretch.
1
RKPA5300
2 - If the tension is too tight. Loosen the grease nipple (1) slowly to allow grease to flow out of the valve. The grease contained in the stretching cylinder is under pressure and could injure the operator. For this reason the valve should not be loosened by more than one turn. H If the grease does not flow easily, move the machine backwards and forwards slowly over a short stretch.
H1
2 RKPA5310
PC75R-2
20-31
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
AIR BLEEDING FROM HYDRAULIC CIRCUITS
AIR BLEEDING FROM HYDRAULIC CIRCUITS Order for operations and procedure for bleeding air Air bleeding procedure
Air bleeding item
Nature of work . Replace hydraulic oil . Clean strainer
1
2
3
4
5
6
Bleeding air from pump
Start engine
Bleeding air from cylinder
Bleeding air from swing motors
Bleeding air from travel motor
Start operations
p
p
p
p
p
p
p
p
p
. Replace, repair control valve
p
p
. Replace cylinder
p
p
. Remove suction piping
,1
p
. Replace return filter element . Replace, repair pump
p
,1
. Remove cylinder piping . Replace swing motor . Remove swing motor piping . Replace travel motor, swivel . Remove travel motor, swivel piping
p p
p p p
p p
p
,1: Bleed the air from the swing motors or travel motors only when the oil inside the motor case has been drained
1. Bleeding air from pump P1 H When the hydraulic oil tank is drained, or when the main pumps are removed for revision or replacement, air must be bled from the intake circuit as follows: 1 - Loosen air bleed plug (1) from body pump (2).
1
2 - Fill the tank with oil up to the level of the hole in the plug (1). 3 - Tighten plug (1). Plug: 7.35w1.47 Nm (5.42w1.08 lb.ft.) 4 - Continue to fill the tank until the maximum level is reached.
2
RKPA7700
5 - Starting the engine and run the engine at low idling for 10 minutes. (See «Bleeding air from hydraulic cylinders»)
20-32
PC75R-2
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
AIR BLEEDING FROM HYDRAULIC CIRCUITS
2. Bleeding air from hydraulic cylinders H Once the hydraulic cylinders or the tubes connected to them have been removed, the air must be bleed as follows: 1 - Start the engine and run at idling for approx. 5 minutes. 2 - Run the engine at low idling, then raise and lower the boom 4-5 times in succession. H Operate the piston rod to approx. 100 mm (3.94 in.) before the end of its stroke. 3 - Increase engine speed to high idling and repeat the operations described at point 2. Reduce engine speed to low idling and take the piston through its entire stroke until the hydraulic pump has reached maximum pressure. 4 - Repeat the operations (starting from point 2) for the cylinders of the 2nd boom, the arm and the bucket.
3. Bleeding air from swing motor
1
1 - Connect hoses (1), drain hose (2) and brake swing release hose (3). 2 - Fill the swing motor case with hydraulic oil from union (4)
3 2
RKPA5320
3 - Connect hose (5). 4 - Start engine at low idling for approx. 10 minutes. 5 - Slowly swing in both direction few times.
5
4
1
2 RKPA5330
PC75R-2
20-33
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
AIR BLEEDING FROM HYDRAULIC CIRCUITS
4. Air bleeding from travel motors 1 - Apply on drain union (1) a temporary hose «A» to catch oil leakage. 2 - Start the engine and bring it to low idling speed for few minutes. 3 - Turn the upper structure of 90ë and, pushing with boom on the bucket, raise the chain track from the ground.
1
4 - Slowly turn the raised chain track on both direction until from oil drain hose the oil comes out without air bubbles.
RKPA5340
5 - Stop the engine and connect the drain hose (1). 6 - Repeat the drain operation also for the other chain track.
A
RKPA5350
20-34
PC75R-2
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
RELEASING RESIDUAL PRESSURE FROM THE CIRCUITS
RELEASING RESIDUAL PRESSURE FROM THE CIRCUITS 1 - Rest the work equipment on the ground and stop the engine. 2 - Put the ignition key at position «I» and move the control lever in all directions to relieve all pressure in the main hydraulic circuits and the PPC valves. 3 - Turn the ignition key to position «O» (OFF) and remove it. 4 - Put the lever of the safety device into the «LOCKED» position. 5 - Slowly loosen the oil-tank filler-cap to release any residual pressure.
PC75R-2
0 1
0 1
RKP10570
20-35
CHECKING AND REGULATING PRESSURE IN THE HYDRAULIC CIRCUITS
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
CHECKING AND REGULATING PRESSURE IN THE HYDRAULIC CIRCUITS INTRODUCTION
3
.
123-
Main relief valve (Section 1) Main relief valve (Section 2) Safety valve
SEZIONE 2 SECTION
.
SECTION 1 SEZIONE 1
The control valve is divided into two normally independent sections, supplied by pumps P1 e P2 respectively. Each section is protected against overpressures by a main (or primary) relief valve with a regolable cartridge. Each section is protected by safety valve with pre-setting cartridge.
.
P2 DIESEL DIESEL
P1
P2 TANK SERBATOIO
2 P1
1 RKP10580
The sections consist of the spools that govern:
.
Section
Control
1
Swing (Left-Right) Blade (Down-Up)
2
L.H. travel motor (Backward-Forward) R.H. travel motor (Forward-Backward) Boom (Raise-Lower) Arm (Open-Close) Bucket (Curl-Dump) Boom swing (Left-Right) Attachment (L.H. side - R.H. side) ] 2-piece boom (Down-Up)
] Optional
Ports A1 - B1 A2 - B2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 A9 A10
-
B3 B4 B5 B6 B7 B8 B9 B10
PORTS UTILIZZI
20-36
9 10 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
9 10 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 A
B
RKP10590
PC75R-2
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
TESTING AND SETTING OF MAIN VALVES
TESTING AND SETTING OF MAIN VALVES H Check condition: . Engine: at working temperature . Engine idling MIN. and MAX.: within standard values . Hydraulic oil: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) . WORKING MODE selector: position P . Swing lock pin: applied. Release the remain pressure from circuits. (See «REMAIN PRESSURE REMOVAL FROM CIRCUITS»).
1. Main valve Section 1 1 - Connect to pressure port M1 the gauge E3 (400 bar). 2 - Start the engine and bring the accelerator on high idling speed position.
M1
E3
3 - Acting on one of upper attachments (boom, arm, bucket) bring the piston rod at the end of its stroke and check that the pressure value reading on gauge is 265w5 bar (3842.3w72.5 psi). H If the reading values on gauge are not the same as shown, proceed to main valves setting.
RKPB1250
2. Main valve Section 2 1 - Connect to pressure port M1 the gauge E3 (400 bar). 2 - Start the engine and bring the accelerator on high idling speed position. 3 - Raise the blade up to the end of stroke and check that the gauge connected to port M2 shows a pressure of 206w5 bar (2987.6w72.5 psi). 4 - Put the blade on the ground and make the upper structure swing on both directions; check that the gauge connected to port M2 shows a pressure value of 206w5 bar (2987.6w72.5 psi). H If the pressure values are lower than the value shown, check the safety valves of swing motor.
E3
M2
RKPB1000
PC75R-2
20-37
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
TESTING AND SETTING OF MAIN VALVES
3. Main valves setting To make the valve setting, prepare the machine in the same way as for pressure testing. a Section 2 1nd Sezione
1 - Loosen the locking nut (1). 2 - Adjust the pressure with screw (2). . To INCREASE the pressure turn in CLOCKWISE direction. . To DECREASE the pressure turn in COUNTERCLOCKWISE direction.
12sta Sezione Section
3 - Lock the position with nut (1). Locking nut: 49 ± 59 Nm (36.1 ± 43.5 lb.ft.)
RKPA5360
1
2 RKP10600
20-38
PC75R-2
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
ADJUSTING PC VALVE
ADJUSTING PC VALVE H In case the engine speed lowers as a load becomes larger, or in case the work equipment speed is slow even though the engine speed, pump discharge pressure and LS differential pressure are normal, adjust the PC (1) valve according to the following procedure. 1 - Loosen the lock nut (2). For the cases of slow speed, turn the sleeve (3) clockwise, and for the cases of lowering of engine speed, turn the sleeve counterclockwise. H Clockwise rotation of the sleeve «increases» the suction torque of the pump, and counterclockwise rotation «decreases» the absurption torque. H Rotation range of the sleeve (3) shall be within 180ë for both clockwise and counterclockwise. 2 - After adjustment finished, tighten the lock nut (2). Lock nut: 100.5w12.3 Nm (74w9.06 lb.ft.)
1
RKPB0500
2
3 RKP10610
PC75R-2
20-39
MEASURING LS DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE AND ADJUSTING LS VALVE
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
MEASURING LS DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE AND ADJUSTING LS VALVE 1. Measuring DPLS differential pressure i) Disconnect pipe (1) and connect a Tee on the union (2); screw an adapter (3) on the Tee. Connect pipe (1).
2 3
1 RKPA5370
3
E5
RKPB1500
ii) Connect the pressure gauge E5 to adapter (3) on control valve and to adapter M1 (delivery pump P1). iii) Measure the DPLS differential pressure according to the conditions shown in table 1. Table 1 Work mode
Fuel lever
Operation
P
Full
Lever at NEUTRAL
P
Full
Vehicle speed with increment Travel idling (lever full)
Differential pressure bar (psi)
M1
25 - 39 (362.5 - 565.6) 21w1 (304.6w14.5)
RKPB1010
NOTE: Travel idling at one side
20-40
PC75R-2
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
MEASURING LS DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE AND ADJUSTING LS VALVE
2. Adjusting of the LS valve If the values obtained during the measurement of the differential pressure according to the foregoing conditions are not in the standard value range, adjust the LS valve (3) according to the following procedure.
3
1 - Loosen the lock nut (4) and turn the screw (5) to adjust. . Turn the screw: CLOCKWISE to increase the differential pressure; COUNTERCLOCKWISE to decrease the differential pressure. . Adjusting amount for one turn of the screw: 13.2 kg/cm2 (187.7 psi). 2 - After-the adjustment finished, tighten the locknut (4). Lock nut: 56.4w7.4 Nm (41.6w5.45 lb.ft.)
RKPB0501
4
NOTE: Make sure to adjust the LS valve with measuring the differential pressure.
5 RKP10620
PC75R-2
20-41
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
CHECKING AND ADJUSTING PRESSURES IN THE SERVOCONTROL FEED UNIT
CHECKING AND ADJUSTING PRESSURES IN THE SERVOCONTROL FEED UNIT H Test conditions: . Hydraulic oil: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF)
M3
Release any residual pressures from the circuits (See «RELEASING RESIDUAL PRESSURES FROM THE CIRCUITS»). 1 - Connect the pressure gauge E1 to the adapter M3.
E1
2 - Start the engine and move the accelerator into its maximum position. 3 - Put the lever of the safety device in its working position, (UNLOCKED).
RKPB1020
4 - Bring a servocontrol circuit up to pressure by operating the work equipment (i.e. bucket). 5 - Check the working pressure on the pressure gauge E1. H Working pressure: 29 3.5 bar (420.6 50.8 psi) H If the working pressure is lower that the permissible value, check servocontrol feed unit valve
RKP10630
20-42
PC75R-2
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
MEASURING PUMPS DELIVERY AND FLOW CONTROL STARTING POINT PUMP P1
MEASURING PUMPS DELIVERY AND FLOW CONTROL STARTING POINT PUMP P1 H Test conditions: . Engine: at working temperature. . Hydraulic oil: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) . WORKING MODE selector: position P. . Work equipment on the ground and made safety. . Swing lock pin inserted
1. Connecting the flowmeter 1 - Disconnect the delivery tube of the pump to be tested. 2 - Connect the delivery outlet of the pump to the inlet port of the flowmeter F1. 3 - Connect the discharge port of the flowmeter to the tube disconnected in phase 1. 4 - Mount a rev. counter (C1 or C2) to measure that the delivery from the tested pump is within the tolerances allowed for the rated engine rpm. H If an electronic pressure-transducer type rev. counter is installed on a diesel supply tube to the nozzle, make sure that it is mounted at a distance from the hose-clamps. H When measuring deliveries with the pumps mounted on the machine, it is difficult to use the accelerator to count the precise number of revs needed for this test. Make delivery measurements with the engine running at a speed close to the test speed and then make a proportional calculation.
To valve Alcontrol distributore
1 From hydraulic Dalla pompapump
F1 RKP10640
Example: MEASUREMENT Engine speed: 2275 rpm Delivery: 108.80 ,/min (28.744 US.gpm) PROPORTIONAL DELIVERY AT 2300 rpm 108.80 x 2300 = 110 ,/min ÐÐÐÐ 2275 28.744 x 2300 = 29.059 US.gpm ÐÐÐÐ 2275
2. Measurement for pump P1 1 - Start the engine and bring it up to a speed of 2300 rpm. 2 - Adjust the delivery pressure with the flowmeter knob (1) and measure the effective delivery of the pump. H Perform this test several times, varying the pressure to cover the entire duty range (max. 265 bar (3843 psi)). H Measure the flow values at each 9.8 bar (142.1 psi) of pressure variation.
F1 1
RKPB0660
PC75R-2
20-43
3 - Check the flow ± pressure values against the values of «P MODE» diagram as shown on «TECHNICAL SPECIFICATION» making if necessary, the proportional calculating to obtain the flow values referred to 2300 rpm/min. necessary to make the control. If the measured values are lower than those permissible, it is necessary to overhaul or to replace the pump. NOTE: Making the flow readings each 9.8 bar (142.1 psi), also the initial pump regulation is made, that, in the operating mode «P», corresponds to a pressure of 137w4 bar (1987w58 psi).
MEASURING PUMPS DELIVERY AND FLOW CONTROL STARTING POINT PUMP P1
Q (ᐍ /min) (gpm)
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
200 (52.8)
178 (47) 170 (44.9) 150 (39.6)
Maximum delivery Point of initial regulation
100 (26.4)
Minimum delivery
4 - Turn the WORKING MODE selector on position E and repeat the checks comparing the flow values with «E MODE» curve. 5 - Raise the working attachments, turn the WORKING MODE selector on position S and start the upper structure rotation; keeping the lever to the end of stroke, make the flow-pressure measurements and compare the values with the «S MODE» curve.
50 (13.2)
Gear pump P2 pressure: 19.6 bar (284.4 psi) 0 49 (711)
98 (1422)
137.2 (42.6)
196 (2844)
265 P(bar) (3839) (psi) RKP10651
3. Measurement of pump P2 1 - Start the engine and bring it at idling of 2300 rpm/ min.
F1
2 - Adjust the delivery pressure with flowmeter F1 knob (1) at 29.4 bar (426.4 psi). 3 - Check the flow ± pressure values against the values shown on «TECHNICAL SPECIFICATION» making if necessary, the proportional calculating to obtain the flow values referred to 2300 rpm/ min necessary to make the control. If the measured value is lower than that permissible, it is necessary to overhaul or to replace the pump.
20-44
1 RKPB0670
PC75R-2
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
MEASURING TRAVEL DEVIATION
MEASURING TRAVEL DEVIATION H Test conditions: . Engine: at working temperature. . Hydraulic oil: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) . WORKING MODE selector: position P. . Track-shoe tension: within the correct range H Let the machine travel over a firm, flat surface.
45°
1. Measuring the deviation Release any residual pressures (See «RELEASING RESIDUAL PRESSURES FROM THE CIRCUITS»).
RKP07460
1 - Connect the pressure gauge E3 (400 bar) to adapter M1. 2 - For this measurement the boom, arm and bucket must be folded into the appropriate travelling positions. H Fully extend the cylinder of the arm and bucket, and position the boom at 45ë.
M1
3 - Bring the engine up to high idling speed. 4 - Push the travel lever forwards to the end of its stroke. 5 - Travel for 10 metres (32.8 ft.) and then measure the deviation accomplished by the machine over the next 20 metres (65.6 ft.). H During travel operation check discharge pressure of pump P1.
RKPB1030
Travel straight through without stopping for 20 m (65.6 ft.)
Travel for 10 m (32.8 ft.)
10 m (32.8 ft.)
Make a mark
20 m (65.6 ft.)
Make a mark
Line mark on the ground
10 m (32.8 ft.)
Make a mark
0
a Mark
PC75R-2
Mark Measure the dimension a of the deviation
Mark RKP07471
20-45
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
ADJUSTING THE MAXIMUM SPEED OF THE TRAVEL MOTORS
ADJUSTING THE MAXIMUM SPEED OF THE TRAVEL MOTORS H Test conditions: . Engine: at working temperature. . Hydraulic oil: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) . WORKING MODE selector: position P. . Track-shoe tension: within the correct range
1. Test 1 - Swing the revolving frame 90ë towards the track-shoe to be checked, and position the arm perpendicular to the ground. RKP07450
2 - Rest the back of the bucket on the ground and, pushing down with the boom and the arm, raise the machine until the track-shoe is at least 10 cm above the ground. 3 - Make a distinct mark (1) for the test. 4 - Bring the engine up to high idling speed.
C2
1
5 - Move forwards the travel lever of the travel motor to be tested and press the speed increment pedal. 6 - Measure the rotation speed of the driving wheel with the tachometer C2. H Low speed: 34w2 rpm 7 - Change to high speed travelling and check again.
RKPA5400
H High speed: 57.6w2 rpm 8 - Make this measurement in both directions of rotation and for both track shoes. The rotation speed should be the same for both motors.
20-46
PC75R-2
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
MEASURING INNER OIL LEAKAGE OF TRAVEL MOTOR
MEASURING INNER OIL LEAKAGE OF TRAVEL MOTOR When measuring oil leakage from the travel motor, mistaken operation of the levers can lead to accidents. Make this works using two persons and always follow agreed signals when measuring. H Check condition: . Hydraulic oil: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) . WORKING MODE selector: position P . Tracks tension: within the permissible values . Upper structure: turned of 180ë. 1 - Remove the covers (1).
1 RKPA5410
2 - Disconnect drain hose (2) from the travel motor to check and fit a blind plug at the hose end. 3 - Connect to travel motor a temporary hose «A» to catch possible oil leakages. 4 - Put a steel bar «B» of 70 mm (2.758 in.) diameter between sprocket and frame. 5 - Run the engine and start to rotate the blocked sprocket; bring gradually the engine at full throttle and bring the travel lever control to the end of its stroke.
A
2
6 - Relieve the circuit for 30 seconds and then measure the leakage for the next minute. H When measuring, move the motor slightly (move the position of the valve plate and cylinder, and piston and cylinder), and measure several times.
RKPA5351
7 - Stop the engine and, with the same procedure, make the measuring for the other travel motor.
B
RKPA5430
PC75R-2
20-47
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
ADJUSTING BOOM AND ARM SAFETY VALVES
ADJUSTING BOOM AND ARM SAFETY VALVES H Test conditions . Engine: at working temperature . Hydraulic oil: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) . WORKING MODE selector: position P . Secondary valves: set to normal values. (See «SETTING OF PRIMARY AND SECONDARY VALVES»).
Boom
V2
1
2
1 - Rest the work equipment on the ground, stop the engine and release any residual pressures (See «RELEASING RESIDUAL PRESSURES FROM THE CIRCUITS»).
C2 RKPB1040
2 - Disconnect the pipe (1) from the coupling V2 and the pipe (2) from coupling C2. H Disconnect the safety valve from the arm cylinder.
Arm
1
3 - Cap the pipe (2) to prevent entry of impurities. H For the arm, cap the cylinder.
C1
4 - Connect the tube (1) to the coupling C2. H For the arm, connect the flange V2 to the coupling C2. 5 - Unscrew the nut (6) and remove the threaded rod (5) and the nut (4).
V2
6 - Start the engine and bring it up to high idling speed. 7 - Bring the boom cylinder bottom side or the arm cylinder head side slowly up to maximum pressure (270 bar (3916 psi)), checking that no oil leaks out of the valve. 8 - Maintaining pressure, adjust the valve with the screw (3), until a slight leakage of oil (just a few drops every minute) is seen coming from the flange V2. . To INCREASE pressure, turn in a CLOCKWISE direction. . To DECREASE pressure, turn in an COUNTERCLOCKWISE direction. H Every turn of the screw (3) changes the pressure by 110 bar (1595.3 psi).
RKPB1050
Nm
Nm
5 6 70 Nm (51.6 lb.ft.) 4 140 Nm (103.2 lb.ft.)
10
3 7 V2
9 - Block the screw (3) in position with the nut (4). Locknut: 70 Nm (51.6 lb.ft.) 10 - Screw the rod in (5) until it comes into contact with the retaining element (7) and then turn it back for 5-6 turns. Secure it in position with the nut (6). 11 - Rest the equipment on the ground, stop the engine, and release any residual pressures.
C2
T
12 - Re-assemble the valve connections.
P
RKP07441
20-48
PC75R-2
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
ADJUSTING 2nd BOOM SAFETY VALVES
ADJUSTING 2nd BOOM SAFETY VALVES H Test conditions: . Engine: at working temperature . Hydraulic oil: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) . WORKING MODE selector: position P . Secondary valves: set to normal values. (See «SETTING OF PRIMARY AND SECONDARY VALVES»).
4 6 5
2
3 8
1 - Rest the work equipment on the ground, stop the engine and release any residual pressures (See «RELEASING RESIDUAL PRESSURES FROM THE CIRCUITS»). H Adjust the valves of one cylinder at a time.
1 7 RKPA5460
2 - Disconnect the pipes (1), (2), (3) and (4). 3 - Use hoses of equal section to connect up the pipes in the following manner: pipe (1) port (5). pipe (2) port (6)
10
9
4 - Cap pipes (3) and (4) to prevent entry of any impurities. 5 - Remove the access caps (9) to the adjustment screws (10) and (11). 6 - Start the engine and bring it up to high idling speed.
13 7
7 - Move the 2nd boom pedal to the end of its opening stroke. 8 - Adjust the valve (12) until a slight leakage of oil can be seen from the flange (8). . To INCREASE pressure, turn in a CLOCKWISE direction. . To DECREASE pressure, turn in an COUNTERCLOCKWISE direction. H Every turn of the screw changes the pressure by 165 bar (2393 psi).
5
9 - Move the 2nd boom pedal to the end of its closing stroke. 10 - Using the procedure indicated in point 8 adjust the valve (13) until a slight leakage of oil is visible from the port (7).
6
11 - Stop the engine and release any residual pressures. 12 - Replace the caps (9) and re-assemble the hydraulic circuits. Locknut 20 Nm (14.74 lb.ft.)
8
12
13 - Repeat the same regulation operations for the valves of the other cylinder.
11
9 RKP07430
PC75R-2
20-49
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
MEASURING AND SETTING OF PRESSURE SWITCH SIGNAL OVERLOAD OPERATION
MEASURING AND SETTING OF PRESSURE SWITCH SIGNAL OVERLOAD OPERATION NOTE: The illustration shows the pressure switch without guard. H Check condition: . Engine: at working temperature . Hydraulic oil: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF)
M1
E3
1 - Connect to pressure port M1 the gauge E3 ( 400 bar). 2 - Start the engine and bring it at medium throttle. 3 - Apply the overload alarm. 4 - Raise boom until the lift end of stroke and increase lowly the pressure; check the pressure value when appear the overload signal. H Standard operating pressure: 130 bar (1885.4 psi)
RKPB1250
Setting If the operating pressure in not within the standard limits, make the pressure switch (1) setting as follows: 1 - Remove cover (2). 2 - Raise the boom checking on gauge E3 that hydraulic cylinder approach the operating pressure. 3 - Loose the dowel (3) and turn the adjusting screw (4) until to obtain the overload alarm signal. . To INCREASE the operating pressure, turn the screw in CLOCKWISE direction. . To DECREASE the operating pressure, turn the screw in COUNTERCLOCKWISE direction.
2
1
RKPB5610
4 - Lock the position with dowel (1). 5 - Release the pressure and repeat several times the measuring to check the setting stability.
4
3
RKPB5620
20-50
PC75R-2
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
MEASUREMENT OF INTERNAL OIL LEAKAGES IN THE SWING MOTOR
MEASUREMENT OF INTERNAL OIL LEAKAGES IN THE SWING MOTOR H Test conditions: . Engine: at working temperature . Hydraulic oil: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) . WORKING MODE selector: position P . Revolving frame: secured by the rotation-blocking pin. 1 - Disconnect the drainage hose (1) of the motor (2). 2 - Attach a provisional hose to collect the drainage oil. 3 - Start the engine and bring it up to high idling speed. 4 - Push the swing control lever as far as it will go.
1
2
RKPA5321
5 - Hold it in this position for 30 seconds and then measure the oil leakage for the next minute. 6 - Reduce motor speed to low idling, swing the revolving frame 180ë and repeat the measurement. 7 - Check that the average between the two measurements falls within the normal range. (See «TECHNICAL DATA»). 8 - Re-assemble the hydraulic drainage circuit.
PC75R-2
20-51
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
CHECKING FOR LEAKAGES INSIDE THE SWIVEL JOINT
CHECKING FOR LEAKAGES INSIDE THE SWIVEL JOINT H Test conditions: . Engine: at working temperature. . Hydraulic oil: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) . WORKING MODE selector: position P. 1.
9
RH travel motor - Forwards
8
LH travel motor - Backwards
Functionality test
7
RH travel motor - Backwards
1 - When one of the lower-level tools (blade, travel motors, speed increment, brakes) is found to be defective, one of the causes of the failure may be the swivel joint.
6
LH travel motor - Forwards
5
Blade cylinder bottom edge (descent)
4
Drainage travel motor
3
Blade cylinder top edge (rise)
2
Travel speed increment
1
Free
2 - To confirm the defect it is sufficient to by-pass the joint by connecting (using an additional length of tubing) the input and output hoses of the joint of the branch to be checked. If the defect disappears, it is certainly due to the swivel joint. If the defect remains, it can be due to other causes, but not to the swivel joint. 2.
Identification of defective seal These tests should be performed on those branches subjected to working pressures. Tests on unstressed or unused branches are therefore excluded. The test method consists in pressurising the branch under examination and measuring any leakage from adjacent branches, as set out in the following table:
Në
Branch to be tested (under pressure)
9
RH travel motor - Forwards
8
LH travel motor - Backwards
7
RH travel motor - Backwards
6
LH travel motor - Forwards
5
Blade cylinder bottom side (descent)
3
Blade cylinder head side (rise)
2
Travel speed increment
1
Free
Adjacent parts (Leakages)
Në
External leakage (visible)
±
LH travel motor - Backwards
8
RH travel motor - Forwards
9
RH travel motor - Backwards
7
LH travel motor - Backwards
8
LH travel motor - Forwards
6
RH travel motor - Backwards
7
Blade cylinder bottom edge (descent)
5
LH travel motor - Forwards
6
Drainage travel motor
4
Drainage travel motor
4
Travel speed increment
2
Blade cylinder top edge (rise)
3
Free
1
±
2 ±
±
The numbers correspond to the numbers stamped on the input and output ports of the swivel joint.
20-52
PC75R-2
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
CHECKING FOR LEAKAGES INSIDE THE SWIVEL JOINT
3.
Preparation for testing: travel motors travel brakes speed increment 1 - Relieve all residual hydraulic pressures (See «RELEASING RESIDUAL PRESSURES FROM THE CIRCUITS»). 2 - Identify the branch involved in the test (1). 3 - Disconnect the hoses (2) from the branches adjacent to the part to be tested and cap them tightly. Make sure that the detached tubes are securely sealed, to prevent jets of high-pressure oil escaping if circuits that are not undergoing tests should accidentally become pressurised. H The tubes of the adjacent branches must be disconnected from the upper parts of the swivel joint. . . .
1 2
3
RKP07420
4 - Provisional hoses (3) for collecting any oil leakages should be connected to the inlets of the branches adjacent to the one being tested. 4. Preparation for testing the blade 1 - Relieve all residual hydraulic pressures (See «RELEASING RESIDUAL PRESSURES FROM THE CIRCUITS»). 2 - Identify the branch involved in the test. 3 - Disconnect the tube corresponding to the branch to be tested from the safety valve input and cap it. Make sure that the detached tubes are securely sealed, to prevent the escape of jets of oil at high pressure. 4 - Cap the valve to prevent entry of impurities. 5 - Disconnect from the swivel joint the hoses (2) of the branches adjacent to the branch to be tested, and cap them tightly. Make sure that the detached hoses are securely sealed, to prevent jets of high-pressure oil escaping if the circuits that are not undergoing tests should accidentally become pressurised. H The tubes of adjacent branches must be disconnected from the upper parts of the swivel joint.
3
1
3
RKP07410
6 - Provisional hoses (3) to collect any leaking oil should be connected to the inlets of the branches adjacent to the one being tested. 5. Test 1 - Start the engine and bring it up to the test speed described for each group or component. 2 - Pressurise the branch to be tested. 3 - After 30 seconds, watch for another minute if there are any leakages. H If oil leaks out of one of the two provisional hoses, it means that there is a leakage in the intermediate gasket between the branch connected to the provisional hose and the pressurised branch.
PC75R-2
20-53
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
ANALYSIS OF THE CAUSES OF HYDRAULIC DRIFTS
ANALYSIS OF THE CAUSES OF HYDRAULIC DRIFTS H If hydraulic drift occurs in the work equipment, a check must be carried out to see if the cause is due to a cylinder gasket or to the control valve. H Conditions for all checks: . Engine: at working temperature. . Hydraulic oil: 45 ± 55ëC (113 ±131ëF) . Removal and connection of tubes only after relief of residual pressures. (See «RELEASING RESIDUAL PRESSURES FROM THE CIRCUITS»).
RKP07400
1.
Boom test 1 - Position the machine with the arm vertical and the bucket on the ground, resting on its back.
3
2 - Stop the engine and release any residual hydraulic pressure. 3 - Disconnect the hose (1) that feeds the cylinder on the head side. H Plug the hose to keep out impurity 4 - Disconnect the hose (2) and plug it to keep out impurity. 5 - Remove safety valve (3) together with the pipe (4) and plug the bottom side under port using flange L1. H Plug the pipe to keep out impurity.
4
2
1 RKPB1041
6 - Start the engine and extend the arm completely. 7 - Stop the engine and check the position of the boom for 5 minutes. . If the boom drops, the drift is due to the cylinder gasket. . If the boom does not drop, the drift is due to the control valve.
2.
Arm test 1 - Position the machine with the arm completely extended and the bucket teeth on the ground. 2 - Stop the engine and release any residual hydraulic pressure.
RKP07390
20-54
PC75R-2
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
ANALYSIS OF THE CAUSES OF HYDRAULIC DRIFTS
3 - Disconnect the hoses (1) and (2) from the pipes and plug them to keep out impurity.
2
Standard
3
4 - Plug the hose (1) feeding the cylinder on the head side and connect a provisional hose on the bottom side to collect any leating oil. Safety valve version 5 - Remove the safety valve (3) from the cylinder and plug it to keep out impurity.
1
6 - Plug the head side cylinder port using flange L1.
RKPB1060
All version 7 - Start the engine and raise the boom. 8 - Stop the engine and check the position of the arm for 5 minutes. . If the arm drops, the drift is due to the cylinder gasket. . If the arm does not drop, the drift is due to the control valve.
RKP07380
3.
Testing the functionality of the boom and arm safety valve. H This test should be carried out after having checked that the drift is not due to the cylinder gaskets (See «BOOM TEST» and «ARM TEST»), and after having checked the valve settings (See «ADJUSTING BOOM AND ARM SAFETY VALVES»).
V2
1
2
1 - Depending upon which valve is to be checked, position the machine as for the «Boom test» or for the «Arm test».
C2
2 - Disconnect the hose (1) that supplies the valve (port V2).
RKPB1040
3 - Disconnect: For the boom, the head side pipe. For the arm, the bottom side pipe. 4 - Start the engine and extend the arm completely for the «Boom test», or raise the boom for the «Arm test».
1 V2
5 - Stop the engine and check for leakages from the valve for 5 minutes. . If there is any leakage, the valve is defective.
RKPB1051
PC75R-2
20-55
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
4.
ANALYSIS OF THE CAUSES OF HYDRAULIC DRIFTS
2nd boom test 1 - Position the machine with the arm and the 2nd boom completely extended. Rest the bucket teeth on the ground. 2 - Stop the engine and release any residual hydraulic pressures.
RKP07370
3 - Disconnect the two pipes (1) and (2) and cap them to prevent entry of impurities. H If a safety valve has been installed, remove it. 4 - Cap the cylinder couplings on the bottom side and attach provisional hoses on the head side to collect any leaking oil.
1
2 RKPA5540
5 - Start the engine and raise the boom. 6 - Stop the engine and check the position of the 2nd boom for 5 minutes. . If the 2nd boom closes, the drift is due to the cylinder gasket. . If the 2nd boom does not close, the drift is due to the control valve. To check one cylinder at a time, proceed as follows:
50 cm (19.7 in.)
7 - Rest the bucket on the ground and release any residual hydraulic pressures. 8 - From one cylinder remove the cap mounted on the bottom side during phase 4.
RKP07361
9 - Start the engine, raise the boom and then stop the engine. 10 - Check the position of the 2nd boom for 5 minutes. . If the 2nd boom closes, the drift is due to the gaskets of the cylinder that has been capped. 11 - Repeat the operation from phase 8 to phase 10 to test the other cylinder.
20-56
PC75R-2
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
5.
ANALYSIS OF THE CAUSES OF HYDRAULIC DRIFTS
Testing the functionality of the 2nd boom safety valves H This test should be performed after having ascertained that the drift is not due to the cylinders. (See «2nd BOOM TEST») and after having checked the adjustment of the safety valves (See «ADJUSTING 2nd BOOM SAFETY VALVES»).
V2 V1
1 - Position the machine with the arm and 2nd boom fully extended. Rest the bucket teeth on the ground. 2 - Stop the engine and relieve any residual hydraulic pressures.
RKPA5530
3 - Disconnect the connecting tubes of the safety valves (two pipes of ports V1 and V2 for each valve). 4 - Start the engine and raise the boom. 5 - Stop the engine and check the position of the 2nd boom for 5 minutes. . If the 2nd boom tends to close, both safety valves are defective.
50 cm (19.7 in.)
RKP07361
6.
Bucket test 1 - Position the machine with the arm vertical and the bucket horizontal and resting on the ground. Put a weight in the bucket, or fill it with earth. 2 - Stop the engine and release any residual hydraulic pressure. 3 - Disconnect the pipes (1 and 2) of the bucket cylinder and cap them to prevent entry of impurities. 4 - Cap the hole in the bucket cylinder on the bottom side and attach a provisional hose on the head side to collect any oil leakages.
RKP07350
1 2
RKPA5520
PC75R-2
20-57
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
ANALYSIS OF THE CAUSES OF HYDRAULIC DRIFTS
5 - Start the engine and raise the boom. 6 - Stop the engine and check the position of the bucket for 5 minutes. . If the bucket tends to open, the drift is due to the cylinder gasket. . If the bucket does not tend to open, the drift is due to the control valve.
50 cm (19.7 in.)
RKP07341
7.
Boom swing test 1 - Position the machine with the boom, arm and bucket raised and with the revolving frame turned 90ë to the right. 2 - Stop the engine and release any residual hydraulic pressure. 3 - Disconnect the pipes (1 and 2) of the boom swing cylinder and cap them.
15°
4 - Cap the hole in the boom swing cylinder on the bottom side and attach a provisional hose to the head side to collect any oil leakages.
RKP10660
5 - Start the engine and move the machine onto a 15ë slope. 6 - Stop the engine and check the position of the boom for 5 minutes. . If the boom tends to swing, the drift is due to the cylinder gasket. . If the boom does not tend to swing, the drift is due to the control valve.
2
1
RKPA5490
8.
Blade test 1 - Position the machine with the arm vertical and resting on the ground, and with the bucket resting on its back. 2 - Bring the blade to roughly half its potential stroke and rest it on a centrally placed block. 3 - Stop the engine and release any residual hydraulic pressure.
27 cm (10.6 in.)
RKP07331
20-58
PC75R-2
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
ANALYSIS OF THE CAUSES OF HYDRAULIC DRIFTS
4 - Disconnect the pipe (1) and the safety valve (2) from the blade cylinder and cap them to prevent entry of dust or foreign bodies. 5 - Cap the hole in the blade cylinder on the head side and attach a provisional hose to the bottom side of the cylinder to collect any oil leakages.
1 2
6 - Start the engine, push down with the boom to raise the machine in order to remove the block on which the blade is resting. 7 - Lower the machine and stop the engine. 8 - Check the position of the blade for 5 minutes. . If the blade tends to sink, the drift is due to the cylinder. . If the blade does not tend to sink, the drift is due to the safety valve group. H To discover whether or not the drift is due to the swivel joint, see «CHECKING FOR LEAKAGES INSIDE THE SWIVEL JOINT - BLADE CIRCUITS».
RKPA5420
RKP07320
PC75R-2
20-59
TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS
ANALYSIS OF THE CAUSES OF HYDRAULIC DRIFTS
9. Swing motor test 1 - Position the machine with boom, arm and bucket raised as in the figure, and with the revolving frame turned 90ë. 2 - Stop the engine and release any residual hydraulic pressure.
RKP07310
3 - Disconnect the hoses (1 and 2) from the motor and cap them to prevent entry of impurities. Attach some provisional hoses to the motor to collect any oil leakages.
1
4 - Disconnect brake swing hose (3) from motor.
2
5 - Connect equipment G1 between motor and hose (3). Check that cock is open and near the hose (3).
3
RKPA5322
6 - Connect gauge E1 to the equipment G1. 7 - Start engine and start swing. H In this way the swing brake will be disengaged.
E1
8 - With the swing brake circuit under pressure (30 bar (435 psi)) close the cock of the equipment G1.
3
G1
RKP08080
9 - Let the machine travel onto a 15ë slope, and stop the engine. 8 - Mark the position between revolving frame and track frame on the swing circle. Check on any swinging movement of the revolving frame for 5 minutes. . If the revolving frame tends to swing, the drift is due to the swing motor. . If the revolving frame does not tend to swing, the drift is due to the control valve H During this test, the pressure indicated on the pressure gauge E1 should not drop below the limit value of 18 bar (*261 psi).
20-60
15°
RKP10670
PC75R-2
GROUP
30
40-28
PC15R-8
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY
HOW TO READ THE MANUAL. . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 3 PRECAUTIONS TO BE TAKEN WHILE WORKING . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 4 SPECIAL TOOLS . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 5 STARTER MOTOR Removal and installation .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 7 ALTERNATOR Removal and installation .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 8 INJECTION PUMP Removal. . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 9 Installation .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 12 NOZZLE HOLDER Removal and installation .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 13 CYLINDER HEAD Removal. . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 14 Installation .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 16 SEAT Removal and installation .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 17 CABIN Removal and installation .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 18 ENGINE HOOD Removal and installation .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 19 FRONT HOOD Removal and installation .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 20 HEATING FAN Removal and installation .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 21 RADIATOR Removal. . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 22 Installation .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 23 FUEL TANK Removal. . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 24 Installation .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 25 HYDRAULIC OIL TANK Removal and installation .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 26 ENGINE-PUMP GROUP Removal. . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 27 Installation .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 30 PUMP GROUP Removal. . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 31 Installation .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 32
PC75R-2
ENGINE-PUMP COUPLING JOINT Removal and installation. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 33 MAIN PUMP INPUT SHAFT OIL SEAL Removal and installation. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 34 GEAR-PUMP Removal and installation. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 35 SWIVEL JOINT Removal and installation. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 36 SWING MOTOR Removal and installation. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 37 SWING MACHINERY Removal and installation. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 38 Disassembly . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 39 Assembly . . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 42 CONTROL VALVE Removal and installation. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 45 REVOLVING FRAME Removal .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 46 Installation. . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 47 COUNTERWEIGHT Removal and installation. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 48 SWING CIRCLE Removal and installation. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 49 TRACK SHOES Removal and installation. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 50 SPROCKET Removal and installation. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 51 TRAVEL MOTOR Removal and installation. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 52 Disassembly . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 53 Assembly . . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 68 BALL BEARING PRELOAD Adjusting . . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 83 AXIAL CLEARANCE ON TAPERED ROLLER BEARINGS Adjusting . . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 84 IDLER AND RECOIL SPRING ASSEMBLY Removal and installation. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 85 IDLER Disassembly and assembly. .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 86
30-1
RECOIL SPRING GROUP Disassembly and assembly . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 87 TRACK ROLLER Removal and installation . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 88 CARRIER ROLLER Removal and installation . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 89 R.H. PPC VALVE (BOOM-BUCKET) Removal . . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 90 Installation. . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 91 L.H. PPC VALVE (ARM-SWING) Removal . . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 92 Installation. . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 93 BLADE PPC VALVE Removal and installation . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 94 TRAVEL PPC VALVE Removal and installation . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 95 BOOM SWING PPC VALVE Removal and installation . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 96 BOOM CYLINDER (1-piece boom) Removal and installation . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 97 BOOM CYLINDER (2-piece boom) Removal . . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 98 Installation. . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 99 2-PIECE BOOM CYLINDER Removal . . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 100 Installation. . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 101 ARM CYLINDER Removal and installation . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 102 BUCKET CYLINDER Removal and installation . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 103
30-2
BOOM SWING CYLINDER Removal and installation . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . 104 BLADE CYLINDER Removal and installation . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . 105 WORK EQUIPMENT CYLINDER Disassembly . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . 106 Assembly . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . 107 WORK EQUIPMENT (1-piece boom version) Removal and installation . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . 111 WORK EQUIPMENT (2-piece boom version) Removal . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . 112 Installation . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . 113 BUCKET Removal and installation . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . 114 ARM Removal . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . 115 Installation . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . 117 2-PIECE BOOM Removal . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . 118 Installation . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . 119 BOOM (1-piece boom version) Removal and installation . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . 120 BOOM (2-piece boom version) Removal . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . 121 Installation . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . 122 SWING SUPPORT Removal and installation . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . 123 BLADE Removal and installation . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . 124
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
HOW TO READ THE MANUAL
HOW TO READ THE MANUAL 1. Removal and Installation of the groups (1) The procedures and information needed to carry out the work of removing or Installing units or groups are given in the removal procedure. The sequence of operations is not repeated in the installation procedure. (2) Information needed for installation is marked with the symbol . The same symbol is repeated at the end of each removal procedure for the same item, to indicate to which installation item it refers. (Example) REMOVAL GROUP : *** : . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Title of operation :. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Safety precautions to be followed when carrying out the operation. 1 - Remove XXXX (1):. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Step in removal procedure. H : . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Technique or important point to remember when removing XXXX (1) 2 - ~ ~ ~ (2): . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
This sign means that information is given for the installation procedure
3 - Remove &&&& (3): ........... ,: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Recovery of oil or water, and the quantity to be recovered. INSTALLATION GROUP *** : . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Title of operation. .
To install, reverse removal procedure. : . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Technique to be used for installation. H : . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Technique or important point to remember when removing ~ ~ ~ (2).
.
Addition of water or oil: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Step in removal procedure. H : . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Point to remember when adding water or oil.
2.
To the precautions to be taken during the removal or installation of the groups, must be added the specific «PRECAUTIONS TO BE TAKEN DURING THE OPERATIONS». Always make sure that these precautions are taken.
3. List of special tools. (1) For details of the descriptions, codes and quantities of each tool (A1; A2 etc.) mentioned in the operational procedures, see the list «SPECIAL TOOLS» supplied in this section.
4. List of the tightening torques and weights, and the quantities oil, liquids or grease needed to fill tanks and containers (1) In the operating procedures, you will find the symbols , , , . In the following order, these represent the values of «TIGHTENING TORQUES», «WEIGHT OF PARTS OR GROUPS», «QUANTITIES OF OIL OR LIQUIDS TO BE INTRODUCED», «SCREW LOCKING MATERIAL, SEALANTS AND LUBRICATION», «LUBRICATING GREASE». NOTE If no symbol is indicated, the values to be used are those given in the introductory sections of this manual.
PC75R-2
30-3
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
PRECAUTIONS TO BE TAKEN WHEN WORKING
PRECAUTIONS TO BE TAKEN WHEN WORKING H When dismantling or installing a part, always take the following general precautions.
1. Precautions for removal operations . . . . . . . . . . . .
If not otherwise indicated, lower the work equipment until it rests on the ground. If the coolant liquid contains an anti-freeze substance, follow the instructions given for drainage. After having removed flanges and tubes, insert plugs to prevent impurities from entering. Before removing a cylinder, fully retract the piston and tie it with wire. Use a sufficiently large container to collect the oil. Before removing a part from the machine, check the alignment reference marks which show the correct installation position. If necessary add further marks to avoid incorrect installation. While dismantling the connectors, always grasp them firmly to avoid undue strain on the wiring. If necessary, attach markers to the wires and tubes to avoid muddling them up during installation. Check the number and height of the adjustments to a given clearance and store them in a safe place. When raising the machine or some parts of it, use adequate equipment for the weight of the part concerned. When using screws or eyebolts to remove items of the machinery, screw them alternately, and as deeply as they will go. Before removing a piece, clean the surrounding area and, after removal, cover the area to prevent dirt or dust from gaining entrance.
2. Precautions to be taken during installation . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tighten nuts and screws with the specified tightening torques. Install the flexible hoses, taking care not to entangle or twist them. Bend the cotter pins and stops in such a way as to secure them. When coating the threads with adhesives, clean the piece to remove oil and grease, then apply just enough adhesive to cover the threading in a uniform manner. When applying a liquid sealant, clean the surface involved, remove residual oil and grease, check that there are no dents or dirt, then apply the liquid sealant in a uniform manner. Clean all the parts, remove dirt, rust, burrs, or dents. Apply a film of engine oil over all the moving parts. Apply a film of anti-friction grease (ASL800040) over all surfaces assembled with pressure, to avoid sticking. After having mounted the snap-rings, check that they are firmly positioned in their seatings. When installing electrical system jacks, remove any oil, dust or water that may have penetrated into them, then connect them firmly. If using eyebolts, check that they are not distorted, screw them in fully, and then align the eye with the hoisting hook. Mount the flanges in a uniform manner, and tighten the screws in criss-cross sequence, to avoid excessive pull on one side only.
3. Precautions to be taken on completion of removal and installation operations. . . .
.
30-4
If the coolant liquid has been drained away, close the drainage plug and add new liquid up to normal level. Start the engine to circulate the liquid throughout the cooling system and then top up the level once more. When the hydraulic equipment has been dismantled, add engine oil to the indicated level. Start up the engine to circulate the oil in the hydraulic circuits, and then top up to the indicated level. If hoses or hydraulic equipment, such as hydraulic cylinders, pumps, motors, solenoid valves and valves, are removed for repairs or substitution, bleed air from the hydraulic circuits after having re-assembled the machine. H For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS». After having re-assembled cylinder joints or cylinders, or work equipment articulations, lubricate thoroughly.
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
SPECIAL TOOLS
SPECIAL TOOLS Nature of work
Symbol
Q.ty
Notes
ATR201320
Coupling for brake and swing release
1
Ð
2
ATR200400
Rear raising equipment
1
Ð
3
ATR200410
Front raising equipment
1
Ð
1
ATR800230
Dynamometric wrench with multiplier
1
Max. 700 kgm (700 dNm)
1
ATR200460
Pin removing tool
1
For track-shoe joint pin - idler
2
ATR200450
Raising equipment
D
1
ATR200420
Swing circle raising equipment
1
Ð
E
1
ATR200430
Press equipment
1
Ð
1
ATR200470
Pliers for mounting gaskets
1
ATR200480
é 50 calibrator
1
ATR201330
é 55 calibrator
1
ATR200490
é 60 calibrator
1
ATR200500
é 70 calibrator
1
ATR201030
é 85 plunger
1
ATR200510
é 90 plunger
1
ATR200520
é 100 plunger
1
ATR201340
é 110 plunger
1
ATR200530
é 120 plunger
1
ATR201030
é 85 calibrator ring
1
ATR200540
é 90 calibrator ring
1
ATR200550
é 100 calibrator ring
1
ATR201350
é 110 calibrator ring
1
ATR200560
é 120 calibrator ring
1
ATR200570
é 50 insertion bushing for piston rod
1
ATR201360
é 55 insertion bushing for piston rod
1
ATR200580
é 60 insertion bushing for piston rod
1
ATR200590
é 70 insertion bushing for piston rod
1
ATR200600
Pliers for mounting snap-ring
1
All cylinders
ATR800240
Socket wrench (6-point 55)
1
Bucket cylinders
ATR800250
Socket wrench (6-point 70)
1
Boom and arm cylinder
ATR200610
Tool for disassembly and assembly cylinders
1
All cylinders
A
Removal/Installation of counterweight Disassembly/Assembly of cylinder nut
B
Removal/Installation of track-shoes
C
Removal/Installation of swing circle Disassembly/Assembly the recoil spring group
2
3
4 F
5
6
7
8
PC75R-2
Description
1
Removal/Installation revolving frame Installation of swing machinery for revolving frame
Disassembly/Assembly the cylinders
Code
For idlers
All cylinders
To calibrate piston rod gaskets
To assemble piston gaskets
To calibrate piston gaskets
To mount flange and head
30-5
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Type of work
Symbol
Replace of pump seal
G
Disassembly/Assembly the swing bracket
H
Disassembly/Assembly swing machinery
Disassembly/Assembly travel motor
30-6
L
M
1
SPECIAL TOOLS
Code
Description
796T-267-1110 Plunger
2
790-201-2730
1
Q.ty 1
Notes Replace of pump seal
Spacer
1
ATR201370
Raising equipment
1
1
ATR501340
Plunger
1
Removal ring
2
ATR501350
Support
1
Removal pinion
3
ATR501360
Plunger
1
Removal pinion
4
ATR501370
Plunger
1
Removal bearing
5
ATR501380
Plunger
1
Mounting seal
6
ATR501390
Plunger
1
Mounting ring
7
ATR501400
Plunger
1
Mounting bearing
8
ATR501410
Plunger
1
Mounting bearing
9
ATR501420
Dynamometer
1
Full scale 20 kg
10
ATR501430
Plunger
1
Place of pinion
11
ATR501440
Plunger
1
Mounting guard
1
ATR501450
Bench
1
Disassembly and assembly
2
ATR501460
Clamp
3
Ð
3
ATR501470
Plunger
1
Mounting spring
4
ATR501480
Bushing
1
Removal and mounting shaft bearing
5
ATR501490
Plunger
1
Mounting gasket
6
ATR501500
Plunger
1
Mounting gear group
7
ATR501510
Guide
1
Mounting bearing
8
ATR501520
Eyebolt
2
M14
9
ATR501530
Eyebolt
2
M16
10
ATR501540
Thickness gauge
1
Ð
Ð
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
STARTER MOTOR
REMOVAL OF STARTER MOTOR Disconnect the lead from the negative (±) battery terminal.
2
1 - Remove upper cover (1) with exhaust pipe (2). 2 - Remove lower guard.
1
RKPA5550
3 - Remove tool box (3) and heat-guard (4).
4 3
RKPB1070
4 - Disconnect electrical cable (5). 5 - Remove screw (6) and starter motor (7).
6 5
7
6 RKPA5560
INSTALLATION OF STARTER MOTOR .
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Screw: 78.4 ± 98 Nm (57.78 ± 72.23 lb.ft.)
PC75R-2
30-7
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ALTERNATOR
REMOVAL OF ALTERNATOR Disconnect the lead from the negative (±) battery terminal.
2
1 - Remove upper cover (1) with exhaust pipe (2).
1
RKPA5550
2 - Remove union (3) of the exhaust pipe.
3
RKPB0680
3 - Disconnect cable (4) and connector (5).
7
4 - Loosen bolts (6), (7) and (8) sufficiently to allow the alternator (9) to be rotate.
5
5 - Free the pulley from the fan-belt (10) and remove alternator (9).
4 6
RKPB5601
INSTALLATION OF ALTERNATOR .
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
10
9
H Check the union gasket of exhaust pipe. H Adjusting of the fan-belt (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»).
8 RKPA5221
30-8
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
INJECTION PUMP
REMOVAL OF INJECTION PUMP Disconnect the cable from accumulator negative terminal (±). H Close the cock (1) of separator (2) to prevent fuel leakage. H Plug removed or disconnected pipes to avoid impurity entry.
1 2
RKPB0690
1 - Disconnect pipe (3) from fuel filter. 2 - Disconnect high pressure pipes (5) from injection pump (4).
5
3
4 RKPA5570
3 - Disconnect from injection pump (4) fuel feeding pipes (6) and return pipes (7).
7
6
RKPA5580
4 - Disconnect pipes (9) and (10) from fuel feed-pump (8). 5 - Disconnect the engine stop solenoid (11) from injection pump (4) and remove the complete unit.
10 11 8 9
RKPA5191
PC75R-2
30-9
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
INJECTION PUMP
6 - Disconnect control cable (13) from accelerator lever (12).
12
13
RKPA5241
7 - Remove the bolt and bracket (14) of injection pump lubricating pipe. 8 - Remove injection pump lubricating pipe (15).
15 14
RKPA5590
9 - Remove screw locking coolant tank (16). 10 - Remove fan guard (17).
16
17 RKPB5630
11 - Remove the inlet cover (18) to ignition gear system and the filler oil plug (19).
19 18
RKPA5600
30-10
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
INJECTION PUMP
12 - Loosen and remove nut (20) and lock washer (21) of pump driving gear (22). H Be careful not to let lock washer drop in the housing.
22
21
20
RKPA5610
13 - Remove pump (4) driving gear (22). H Before removing pump driving gear, mark position compared to idling gear. H For removal, use a puller (X1) and tighten its screws (X2) directly in the gear (22). H Be careful not to damage pump shaft thread. H During removal be careful not to let key drop (23) in the housing.
X2
25 23
22
X1 X2 RKP07800
14 - Remove nuts (24) (No. 4) and injection pump (4) with relative OR rings (25).
4
24
RKPA5591
PC75R-2
30-11
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
INJECTION PUMP
INSTALLATION OF INJECTION PUMP .
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Feed and return pipes: 19.6 ± 24.5 Nm (14.45 ± 18 lb.ft) High pressure pipes: 19.6 ± 24.5 Nm (14.45 ± 18 lb.ft) H Replace safety cotter pin. Lubrication pipe pump side:
9.8 ± 12.7 Nm (7.22 ± 9.36 lb.ft) Lubrication pipe cylinders side: 12.7 ± 16.7 Nm (9.36 ± 12.31 lb.ft.) Stiffening bolt: 22.5 ± 28.4 Nm (16.58 ± 20.94 lb.ft.) Cover gasket: Loctite 518 Timing gear system cover bolts:17.6 ± 22.5 Nm (12.97 ± 16.58 lb.ft.)
H Align marks among gears before to install pump and nut. Gear lock nut: 83.3 ± 93.1 Nm (61.4 ± 68.6 lb.ft.) Pump lock nuts: 34.3 ± 44.1 Nm (25.3 ± 32.5 lb.ft.) 1 - Check fuel injection timing. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»).
Ingranaggio pompa Injection pump d'iniezione
gear
Reference Riferimento
Ingranaggio Idling gear folle RKP07810
30-12
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
NOZZLE HOLDER
REMOVAL OF NOZZLE HOLDER 1 - Remove suction pipe (1) with union (2).
2
1
2 - Disconnect connector (3) of clogging indicator and remove union (4) and filter (5).
3
5
4 RKPB1090
3 - Remove electrical cable bridge (6).
6
RKPA5141
4 - Loosen clips (7) and remove high pressure pipes (8) and fuel recovery pipes (9).
9
5 - Remove collar (11) lock nut (10) and remove nozzle holder (12), seat (13) and guard (14).
7
8
RKPA5620
INSTALLATION OF NOZZLE HOLDER .
To install, reverse the removal procedure. High pressure pipe fittings: 19.6 p 24.5 Nm (14.45p18 lb.ft.) Collar lock nuts: 6.9 p 8.8 Nm (5.1p6.48 lb.ft.)
11
10
12
14 13 RKP07790
PC75R-2
30-13
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CYLINDER HEAD
REMOVAL OF CYLINDER HEAD Disconnect the cable from accumulator negative terminal (±). H Drain the coolant liquid. Coolant liquid: 18
1
, (4.75 US.gall)
1 - Remove coolant tank (1).
RKPB5631
2 - Remove suction pipe (2) with air filter union (3).
3
3 - Remove air filter (4) with union (5)
2
4 5
RKPB1091
4 - Disconnect the cable (6) from the thermostat. 5 - Remove the fastening screws of both electrical cable bridge (7) and lifting brackets; turn the assembly over towards the piston pump.
7
6 - Re-position the previously removed screws and tighten them up. Screw: 22.5 ± 28.4 Nm (16.58 ± 20.93 lb.ft.)
6 RKPA5630
7 - Remove the alternator adjustment bracket (8); disengage the belt and rotate the alternator (9) towards the stationary hood.
10
8
8 - Remove nut (10), screw (11) and remove muffler (12) with support (13).
12 13 11 9
RKPB5710
30-14
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CYLINDER HEAD
9 - Remove fuel filter (14). 10 - Remove clip (15).
15 14 RKPA5571
11 - Disconnect coolant pipe (16) and heating pipe (17) from cylinder head.
16
12 - Remove nozzle holder. (For details, see «REMOVAL OF NOZZLE HOLDER»).
18
17 14
RKPB5720
13 - Remove the valve-tappets cover (18). 14 - Remove the rocker shaft (19). H Loosen lock nut and unscrew valve tappets of 2-3 turns.
19 21 22
15 - Remove the push rods (20).
20
RKP07780
16 - Remove screw (21) and the cylinder head (22) following the indicated order for bolts loosening. H Bolts loosening order: see illustration
BOLT LOOSENING ORDER
Loosen cylinder head bolts in two stages. 18
9
3
11 5
12
4 2
10
17 13
6
14
16
7 1
15
8
RKP07820
PC75R-2
30-15
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CYLINDER HEAD
INSTALLATION OF CYLINDER HEAD .
To install, reverse the removal procedure. 1 - Fill the cooling circuit. Coolant liquid: 18 , (4.75 US.gall) 2 - Start engine to allow liquid circulation in all circuits; stop the engine and check the level. Screw: 22.5 ± 28.4 Nm (16.58 ± 20.93 lb.ft.) H Adjust fan belt tension (for details see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). H Replace exhaust pipe gasket. Nut and screw: 22.5 ± 28.4 Nm (16.58 ± 20.93 lb.ft.)
3 - Check the condition of valves cover gasket and of lock nuts OR rings, clean carefully contact surface on cylinders head. Cover lock nuts: 25w3 Nm (18.42w2.21 lb.ft.) H Check that tappets are firmly engaged in the rods and that the valves collar are correctly assembled. H Start the rocker shaft tightening starting from the center to external. Rocker shaft bolts: 44.1 ± 53.9 Nm (32.5 ±39.7 lb.ft.) H Adjust valves clearance. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). H Assemble a new gasket. H Lubricate with engine oil bolts thread and cylinder block. H Tighten screws, first manually and after in two stages, according to assigned order. Cylinder head bolts. 1st Tightening: 49 ± 59 Nm (36.1 ± 43.5 lb.ft.) Final tightening: 103 ± 113 Nm (75.9 ± 83.3 lb.ft.)
BOLT TIGHTENING ORDER
12
1
8
16 14
7
2 6
13
5
3 10
18
15
9 4
17 11
RKP07830
30-16
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
SEAT
REMOVAL OF SEAT Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground, switch off the engine and remove the ignition key.
1
1 - Raise the front window (1) completely. 2 - Remove the lower window (2) and place it in the supports provided at the back of the cabin. 3 - Remove the four screws (3) that secure the seat. H Slide the seat forwards and backwards in order to reach the screws. 4 - Remove the seat. Seat: 32 kg (70.5 lb.)
INSTALLATION OF SEAT .
2
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
RKPB1280
3
RKPB0940
PC75R-2
30-17
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CABIN
REMOVAL OF CABIN Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground, switch off the engine and remove the ignition key. 1 - Disconnect the connector (1) and hose (2) from the windshield-washer tank and remove all the clamps fixing them.
1 4
2 - Disconnect the heating hose (3) from the diffuser (4).
3
3 - Move the back of the operator's seat completely forward and remove the panel (6) fixing screw (5).
2
4 - Raise the pane (6), disconnect the heating hose (7) from the diffuser (8) and remove the panel (6). 5 - Remove the knob (9), remove the screws (10) (Në 3) and remove the panel (11).
RKPB1110
5
8
6
6 - Disconnect the connector (12).
6
7
7 - Remove the cable fixing screws (13) (në 7). 8 - Remove the upper protective caps and mount the hoisting eyebolts (7). 9 - Attach the eyebolts (7) to the hoisting tackle and move the cabin. Cabin: 250 kg (551 lb.)
RKPB1120
INSTALLATION OF CABIN .
To install, reverse the removal procedure. H Make sure that the short screw (8) is placed on the LH side.
14
14
10
9
12
15 13
11
RKPB11
30-18
RKPB1100
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ENGINE HOOD
REMOVAL OF ENGINE HOOD Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground and switch off the engine. 1 - Detach the gas cylinder (1) from the engine hood (2). 2 - While holding up the engine hood (2) remove the screws (3) that attach the hood to the hinges (4).
1
H Mark the position of any shims. Engine hood: 60 kg (132 lb.)
2 RKPB0560
INSTALLATION OF ENGINE HOOD 3 .
To install, reverse the removal procedure. H Check the centering and adjustment of the closing hook (5). H Position any shims. Replace the cotter pins (6).
4 RKPB0570
6 5 RKPB0950
PC75R-2
30-19
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
FRONT HOOD
REMOVAL OF FRONT HOOD Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground and switch off the engine.
2
1 - Detach the gas cylinder (2) from the support (1).
7
1 RKPA5660
2 - While holding up the engine hood (3), remove the screws (4) that attach (5) the hood to the hinges (3).
4
H Mark the position of any shims. Engine hood: .............kg (.............. lb.)
3 5
INSTALLATION OF FRONT HOOD RKPA5670
.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. H Check the centering and adjustment of the closing hook (6). H Position any shims. Replace the cotter pins (7).
6
RKPA5680
30-20
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
HEATING FAN
REMOVAL OF HEATING FAN Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground and switch off the engine.
2
Disconnect the cable from accumulator negative terminal (±).
3
Drain the coolant liquid to a level below that of the connecting tubes (2-3) between the engine and the heating fan.
1
Cooling liquid: approx. 5 , (1.32 US.gall) 1 - Disconnect clamp (1) and pipes (2) and (3) from the engine and lower the terminals so as to thoroughly drain the liquid from the heating radiator.
RKPA5631
Cooling liquid: approx. 1.5 , (0.396 US.gall)
7
5
2 - Move the back of the operator's seat completely forward and remove the panel (5) fixing screws (4).
5 6
3 - Raise the panel (5), disconnect the heating hose (6) from the diffuser (7). 4 - Remove the knob (8), remove screw (9) (në 3) and remove the panel (10).
4
5 - Move the seat forwards as far as it will go. 6 - Disconnect the pipes (11), remove the side screws (12) that lock the fan unit (13) and disconnect the connector (14).
RKPB1121
7 - Extract the fan unit (9) backwards.
10 9
8
INSTALLATION OF HEATING FAN .
To install, reverse the removal procedure. 1 - Make sure that the heating cock is fully open.
RKPB1140
2 - Fill up with coolant liquid. Quantity of coolant liquid: approx. 7.5 , (1.98 US.gall) 3 - Start the engine to circulate the coolant liquid. 3 - Switch off the engine and top up the level.
13 14
11
12 RKPB1150
PC75R-2
30-21
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
RADIATOR
REMOVAL OF RADIATOR Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground and switch off the engine. Release residual pressures from all circuits. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). Drain the engine coolant liquid and the hydraulic oil. Coolant liquid needed: 18 , (4.75 US.gall) Quantity of oil: 70 , (18.5 US.gall) 1 - Remove the engine hood. (For details, see «REMOVAL OF ENGINE HOOD»).
2 - Remove the top cover (1) together with the exhaust pipe.
1
RKPA5551
3 - Remove tank (2) and fan guard (3). 4 - Disconnect the engine cooling pipes (5) and (6) from the radiator (4) and the suction pipe (7).
4 7 5
2
6
3 RKPB5640
5 - Disconnect the upper pipe (8) from the radiator (4); loosen nut (9).
9
8
RKPB5650
30-22
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
RADIATOR
6 - Disconnect the lower pipe (10) from the radiator (4) and remove the union (11).
11
10 RKPA5723
7 - Loosen screws (12) and remove radiator.
12 RKPB5930
INSTALLATION OF RADIATOR .
To install, reverse the removal procedure. 1 - Refill the coolant liquid circuit. Coolant liquid needed: 18
, (4.75 US.gall)
H Refill the hydraulic oil tank. Quantity of oil: 70 , (18.5 US.gall) 2 - Start the engine at low idling to circulate all the fluids and to fill up the oil coolers. 3 - Stop the engine and top up all levels. 4 - Bleed the hydraulic circuits. (For details see: «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»).
PC75R-2
30-23
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
FUEL TANK
REMOVAL OF FUEL TANK Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground and switch off the engine. Disconnect the lead from the negative (±) battery terminal.
1
H Turn the turret by 45ë towards the right.
2
1 - Remove the front hood (for details, see «REMOVAL OF FRONT HOOD») and the bottom right guard of the turret. 2 - Close the cock (1) of the separator (2).
RKPB0690
3 - Remove the cap of the fuel tank, open the tank drainage cock (5), and drain the fuel.
5
4 - Disconnect the fuel suction pipe (6).
6 RKPB0710
5 - Disconnect the fuel return pipe (7) and the connector (8) of the level gauge (9).
3 7 9 8 RKPB5660
6 - Disconnect the plate (10) that joins the tanks.
10
4 RKPB1170
30-24
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
FUEL TANK
7 - Hook the tank (4) to the hoisting equipment and slightly put the rope under tension. 8 - Remove the screws and remove the tank. Fuel tank: 40 kg (88.2 lb.)
4
RKPB0620
INSTALLATION OF FUEL TANK To install, reverse the removal procedure. H Fill the fuel tank and start the engine.
.
PC75R-2
30-25
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
HYDRAULIC OIL TANK
REMOVAL OF HYDRAULIC OIL TANK Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground and switch off the engine. Release residual pressures from all circuits. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). .
2
Drain the hydraulic oil. Quantity of oil: approx. 70 , (18.5 US.gall)
1
1 - Remove the fuel tank. (For details, see «REMOVAL OF FUEL TANK»). 2 - Disconnect the exhaust pipe (1).
RKPB5680
3 - Disconnect the drain pipes (2) and (3). 4 - Disconnect the coupling (4) of the pump suction pipe and the pipes (5).
5
5 - Remove the bracket (6) of the solenoid valves. 6 - Hook the tank to the hoisting equipment and slightly put the rope under tension.
6
3
7 - Remove the bolts and the oil tank (7). Oil tank: 60 kg (132.2 lb.)
RKPB0731
INSTALLATION OF HYDRAULIC OIL TANK .
4 RKPA5722
To install, reverse the removal procedure. 1 - Fill the hydraulic oil tank to maximum level. While filling, bleed air from the main pump piston. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»).
7
Hydraulic oil needed: approx. 70 , (18.5 US.gall) 2 - Start the engine to circulate the oil and check that there are no leakages. 3 - Switch off the engine, check the level and, if necessary, top it up. RKPB0742
30-26
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ENGINE-PUMP GROUP
REMOVAL OF ENGINE-PUMP GROUP Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground and switch off the engine. Disconnect the lead from the negative (±) battery terminal.
1
Release residual pressures from all circuits. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). .
Drain the hydraulic oil.
.
Quantity of oil: approx. 70 , (18.5 US.gall) Drain the engine coolant liquid.
.
Quantity of coolant liquid: 18 , (4.75 US.gall) Close the feed cock of fuel tank and separator (1).
RKPB0691
1 - Remove the engine hood. (For details, see «REMOVAL OF ENGINE HOOD»).
5
3
4
2 - Remove the top cover (2) complete with the exhaust pipe (3). 3 - Remove the suction pipe (4) complete with the rubber elbow (5) for filter connection.
2
RKPB5730
4 - Remove bottom left and bottom rear guards. 5 - Open the door (6) of the electric board, remove the panel (7) and disconnect the engine cable connector (8) and the earth cable (9). H Free the engine cable from any clip placed between the board and the flywheel.
9 8
7 6 RKPB0750
6 - Disconnect the pipe (11) coming from the separator from the fuel pump (10).
13
7 - Disconnect the return tube (13) from the fuel filter (12).
10 11
12 RKPB0760
PC75R-2
30-27
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ENGINE-PUMP GROUP
8 - Disconnect the cable (14) and the sheathing (15) of the accelerator as well as the earth plait (16) from the engine.
14 15
16 RKPB0630
9 - Remove the compensating tank (17) and move it to one side. 10 - Remove the fan guard (18). 11 - Remove the fastening screws (19) of the conveyor. Push the conveyor towards the engine in order to disengage it from the radiator supports.
21
19
17
22 18 20
RKPB5690
12 - Disconnect the pipes (20) and (21) that connect to the radiator and the heating pipes (22) from the engine. 13 - Disconnect the supporting and guiding clamps of the heating pipes (22) from the engine and extract the pipes from the left opening.
20 21
RKPB0582
14 - Remove the tool box (23) and the heat guard (24).
24 23
RKPB1071
30-28
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ENGINE-PUMP GROUP
14 - Disconnect the flanges of the suction pipes and all delivery pipes (25) from pumps. H Mark the position of Load Sensing, Mode System and servo-control feed pipes in order to avoid mixing them up during installation.
25 25
RKPB1031
15 - Hook the engine (26) to the hoisting equipment using the specific brackets and slightly put the chains under tension.
26
RKPB0770
16 -Remove the central screws (27) (No. 4) of the engine supports (28).
19
20
17 - Slowly lift the unit drawing cables and pipes to and remove the engine (28). Engine - pumps: 460 kg (1013.4 lb.)
RKP10710
PC75R-2
30-29
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ENGINE-PUMP GROUP
INSTALLATION OF ENGINE-PUMP GROUP .
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
H Before connecting the flanges, check the state of seals and keep them in position by applying grease ASL800050. Piston pump flange screws: 63w6.5 Nm (46.3w0.44 lb.ft.) Gear pump flange screws: 35w3.5 Nm (2.65w2.58 lb.ft.) Support bolt: 157 Nm (115.7 lb.ft.) 1 - Fill the hydraulic oil tank to maximum level. While filling, bleed air from the main pump piston. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). Hydraulic oil needed: approx. 70 , (18.5 US.gall) 2 - Fill the cooling circuit. Coolant liquid needed: approx. 18 , (4.75 US.gall) 3 - Start the engine to circulate the oil and check that there are no leakages. 4 - Switch off the engine, check the level and, if necessary, top it up.
30-30
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
PUMP GROUP
REMOVAL OF PUMP GROUP Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground and switch off the engine. Release residual pressures from all circuits. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). .
Drain the hydraulic oil. Quantity of oil: approx. 70 , (18.5 US.gall) 1 - Remove the engine hood. (For details, see «REMOVAL OF ENGINE HOOD»). 2 - Remove left and centre rear guards. 3 - Disconnect the suction flanges and all delivery pipes from the pumps (1) and (2). H Mark the position of Load Sensing, Mode System and servo-control feed pipes in order to avoid mixing them up during installation.
1 2 RKPB1032
6 - Hook the assembly to the eyebolt (3) placed on the piston pump and slightly put the rope under tension. H Pass a harness under the gear pump to prevent tilting of the unit. 7 - Pull out the screws (4) and remove the pump group; disengage the group from the coupling joint shifting it to one side. Pump group: approx. 57 kg (125.6 lb.)
3
4
RKPB0780
PC75R-2
30-31
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
PUMP GROUP
INSTALLATION OF PUMP GROUP .
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
H Before connecting the suction flanges, check the condition of seals and keep them in position applying grease ASL800050 Piston pump flange screws: 63w6.5 Nm (46.3w0.44 lb.ft.) Gear pump flange screws: 35w3.5 Nm (2.65w2.58 lb.ft.) H Coat the coupling surfaces thinly. Coupling surfaces: ASL800050 Pump check screws: Loctite 262 Pump check screws: 50w5 Nm (36.8w0.37 lb.ft.) 1 - Fill the hydraulic oil tank to maximum level. While filling, bleed air from the main pump piston. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). Hydraulic oil: 70 , (18.5 US.gall) 2 - Start the engine to circulate the oil and check that there are no leakages. 3 - Switch off the engine, check the level and, if necessary, top it up.
30-32
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ENGINE-PUMP COUPLING JOINT
REMOVAL OF ENGINE-PUMP COUPLING JOINT Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground and switch off the engine.
1
1 - Remove the piston pump. (For details, see «REMOVAL OF PISTON PUMP»).
half joint pump 2 - Loosen dowel pin (1) fixing half joint (2) in more stages and alternatively.
2
H heat dowel pins to 85 ± 100 ëC (185 ±212ëF) 3 - Remove pump half joint (2). H If necessary, use a puller.
Half joint on flywheel 4 - Remove bolts (3) and flywheel cover (4).
RKPA5730
3
4
INSTALLATION OF ENGINE-PUMP COUPLING JOINT .
RKPA5740
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Pump flange joint mounting bolts: Loctite 262 Pump flange joint mounting bolts: 50 Nm (36.8 lb.ft.) Drive flange bolts: Loctite 262 Drive flange bolts: 50 Nm (36.8 lb.ft.) 1 - Fill up tank unit maximum level. During the filling operation, bleed air from the piston pump (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). Hydraulic oil: 70 , (18.5 US.gall) 2 - Start the engine to allow oil circulation in all systems and check the seals. 3 - Stop the engine and, if necessary, restore oil level in the tank.
PC75R-2
30-33
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
MAIN PUMP INPUT SHAFT OIL SEAL
REMOVAL OF MAIN PUMP INPUT SHAFT OIL SEAL 1 - Remove main pump assembly. (For details, see «REMOVAL OF MAIN PUMP ASSEMBLY»).
1
2 - Remove PTO assembly (1). (For details, see «REMOVAL OF ENGINE - PUMP COUPLING JOINT»). 3 - Remove snap ring (2), then remove spacer (3). 4 - Lever up oil seal (4) with a screwdriver to remove. H When removing the oil seal, be extremely careful not to damage the shaft. RKP07840
INSTALLATION OF MAIN PUMP INPUT SHAFT OIL SEAL .
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
4 2
Lip of oil seal: ASL800050 Coat the outside circumference of the oil seal thinly with ASL800050. then press fit. H Use tools G1 e G2 to press fit oil seal (4).
3
RKP07850
G1
4
G2
RKP10680
30-34
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
GEAR-PUMP
REMOVAL OF GEAR-PUMP Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground and switch off the engine. Release residual pressures from all circuits. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). .
2
Drain the hydraulic oil. Quantity of oil: approx. 70 , (18.5 US.gall) 1 - Disconnect the suction flange (1) and the delivery pipe (2) from the pump. 2 - Remove the bolts (3) and the pump (4), the joint (5) and the gasket (6).
3 4 1 RKPB0280
6 4
5
INSTALLATION OF GEAR-PUMP .
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
3
RKP07860
H Before connecting the suction flange, check the condition of the seal and keep it in its seat by applying grease ASL800050. Flange screws: 35w3.5 Nm (2.65w2.58 lb.ft.) Joint: ASL800050 Pump fastening screws: 98 ± 123 Nm (72.2 ± 90.6 lb.ft.) 1 - Fill the hydraulic oil tank to maximum level. While filling, bleed air from the main pump piston. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). Hydraulic oil needed: approx. 70 , (18.5 US.gall) 2 - Start the engine to circulate the oil and check that there are no leakages. 3 - Switch off the engine, check the level and, if necessary, top it up.
PC75R-2
30-35
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
SWIVEL JOINT
REMOVAL OF SWIVEL JOINT Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground and switch off the engine. Release residual pressures from all circuits. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). Disconnect the lead from the negative (±) battery terminal. 1 - Remove the distributor hood.
1
2 - Disconnect the tubes (1) on the lower side of the joint (2) and plug them. H Mark the tubes before disconnecting them, to avoid errors when re-assembling.
RKPA5750
3 - Disconnect the tubes (3) on the top of the joint (2) and plug them. H Mark the tubes before disconnecting them, to avoid errors when re-assembling.
3
4 - Unscrew and remove the screws (4) of the swivel joint. 5 - Hook the joint (2) to the hoisting equipment and remove it.
2
Swivel joint: 36 kg (79.3 lb.)
RKPA5760
5
INSTALLATION OF SWIVEL JOINT .
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
4 H Before connecting the top pipes, introduce hydraulic oil in the chambers of the branch that is not in use and in the drain branch (branches 1 and 4).
2 RKPA5770
H Grease friction points through the lubricating nipple (5). Swivel joint: ASL800050 1 - Start the engine, move the machine in both directions and move the blade several times to bleed all air from the circuits. 2 - Switch off the engine and top up the oil in the hydraulic tank.
30-36
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
SWING MOTOR
REMOVAL OF SWING MOTOR Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground and switch off the engine.
1
Release residual pressures from all circuits. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»).
3
1 - Disconnect the supply (1), return (2), the brake release pipe (3) and the drain line connection (4).
4 2 - Remove the screws (5) (No. 14) that attach the motor (6) to the swing machinery (7). RKPA5323
3 - Fasten two screws in the holes opposite to each other (8) and remove the motor. Motor: 22 kg (48.5 lb.)
2 1
INSTALLATION OF SWING MOTOR .
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
H Fill the motor with hydraulic oil through the top drain line connection.
4 RKPA5331
Screw: 58.8 ± 73.5 Nm (43.3 ± 54.2 lb.ft.) Coupling surface: ASL800070
6
1 - Start the engine to allow oil circulation in all systems and check the seals.
8
2 - Bleed the air from engine (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»).
7 5 RKPA5780
PC75R-2
30-37
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
SWING MACHINERY
REMOVAL OF SWING MACHINERY Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground and switch off the engine.
1
Release residual pressures from all circuits. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»).
3
1 - Remove the front hood (For details, see «REMOVAL OF FRONT HOOD»).
4
2 - Disconnect the feed pipes (1), the exhaust pipe (2), the brake release pipe (3) and the drain line connection (4). 3 - Remove the check screws (5) (No. 10) of the reduction gear (6).
RKPA5323
4 - Fasten two screws into the holes opposite to each other and remove the reduction gear.
2
5 - Sling the complete assembly and remove it. H During removal, slowly lift the assembly and pay particular attention not to damage the pipes or other parts. Complete group: 43 kg (94.7 lb.)
4 RKPA5332
INSTALLATION OF THE SWING MACHINERY .
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
H In order to centre the holes of the pins and of the fastening screws, connect tool A1 to the hydraulic motor and slowly rotate the motor until the correct angle for the positioning of the reduction gear has been obtained.
6
7
H Fill the motor with hydraulic oil through the drain line connection (2) and lubricate the bearings through the lubricating nipple (7).
5 RKPA5790
Bearing: ASL800050 Screw: 58.8 ± 73.5 Nm (43.3 ± 54.2 lb.ft.)
A1
Coupling surface: ASL800070 1 - Start the engine to allow oil circulation in all systems and check the seals. 2 - Bleed the air from engine (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). RKPA5800
30-38
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
SWING MACHINERY
DISASSEMBLY SWING MACHINERY 1 - Remove drain plug (1) and drain oil from swing machinery case. Remove screws (2) (No. 12) and remove swing motor assembly (3).
3
Swing machinery case: approx. 1.5 , (0.4 US.gall.)
2
1 RKP07740
2 - Remove No. 1 sun gear (4) and No. 1 carrier (5).
4
5 RKP07750
3 - Remove snap ring (6), the remove thrust washer (7), gear (8), bearing (9) and thrust washer (10).
7 8
6 9
10
RKP07590
4 - knock in pin (11) and remove shaft (12). H After removing the shaft (12), remove pin (11). Remove thrust washer (13) from carrier (14).
12 14
13
11
RKP07770
PC75R-2
30-39
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
SWING MACHINERY
5 - Remove No. 2 sun gear (15), ring gear (16) and remove No. 2 carrier assembly (17).
17
15
16 RKP07710
6 - Remove snap ring (18), then remove thrust washer (19), gear (20), bearing (21) and thrust washer (22). Knock in pin (23) and remove shaft (24). H After removing the shaft (24), remove pin (23). Remove thrust washer (25) from carrier (26).
19
18
20 26
21
25
22 23 24 RKP07720
7 - Set shaft and case assembly (27) to press, and push bearing (28) with tool L1. H Operate the press slowly and push the bearing to a point where the split collar (29) can be removed. Remove split collar (29).
L1
27 29
28 RKP07760
8 - Set block L2 to shaft and case assembly (27), and using push tool L3, remove shaft assembly (30) with press. Remove bearing (28).
30
L3
27 L2
28 RKP07730
30-40
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
SWING MACHINERY
9 - Set shaft assembly (30) to press, and using push tool L4, remove bearing (31), and collar (32) from shaft (33).
L4
32 30
31 33 RKP07680
10 - Remove dust seal (34) and oil seal (35) from case (36).
35
34
36 RKP07690
11 - Using puller, remove bearing outer races (37) and (38) from case (36).
37 38
36 RKP07700
PC75R-2
30-41
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
SWING MACHINERY
ASSEMBLY SWING MACHINERY H Clean all parts, and check for dirt or damage. H Coat the sliding surfaces of all parts with engine oil before installing. H Replace the oil seal with a new part.
1 - Using push tool L5, press fit oil seal (35) to case (36). Lip of oil seal: ASL800050
L6 L5
2 - Using push tool L6, press fit outer races (37) and (38) to case (36).
38
36
33
3 - Install collar (32) to shaft (33). Using the tool L7, press fit bearing (31) with press. Set case assembly (39) to shaft assembly (30). Using push tool L8, press fit bearing (28) to a point where split collar (29) can be inserted. H Press fitting force: 11768 N (1200 kg) H Rotate the case and gradually press fit the bearing. Install split collar (29).
37
RKP07650
L7
31
30
32 33 RKP07660
L8
28
39
29
30 RKP07670
30-42
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
4 - Using push tool L10, press fit shaft (30) with press until split collar (29) is fixed in position. Screw bolt (thread é=10 mm (0.394 in.), pitch=1.5 mm (0.059 in.)) in case, and using push-pull scale L9, measure tangential force in direction of rotation. H Tangential force: Max. 147 N (15 kg) H The tangential force is the maximum reading when starting rotation.
SWING MACHINERY
L10
26
L9
33
RKP07610
5 - Using push tool L11, press fit dust seal (34).
L11
34
RKP07620
6 - Install thrust washer (25) to carrier (26). Align position of pin holes of shaft (24) and carrier (26), then tap with a plastic hammer to install shaft (24) and insert pin (23). H After inserting the pin (23), caulk the pin portion of the carrier. H Check that the stepped difference between the shaft (24) and carrier (26) in less than 0.2 mm (0.0079 in.). Assemble thrust washer (22), bearing (21), gear (20) and thrust washer (19), then install snap ring (18). Install No. 2 carrier assembly (17) to shaft and case assembly. 7 - Install ring gear (16). Ring gear mating surface: Loctite 510 Install No. 2 sun gear (15).
19
18
20 26
21
25
22 23 24
Max 0,2mm
RKP07630
15
17
16 RKP07640
PC75R-2
30-43
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
8 - Install thrust washer (13) to carrier (14). Align position of pin holes of shaft (12) and carrier (14), then tap with a plastic hammer to install shaft (12). Insert pin (11). H After inserting the pin (11) caulk the pin portion of the carrier. H Check that the stepped difference between the shaft (14) and carrier (12) is less than 0.2 mm (0.0079 in.).
SWING MACHINERY
12 13
14
Max 0,2mm
11 RKP07580
9 - Assemble thrust washer (7), bearing (9), gear (8) and thrust washer (10), then install snap ring (6).
7
6 9
8
10
RKP07590
10 - Install No. 1 carrier assembly (5). Install No. 1 sun gear (4). Install swing motor assembly (3) and tighten screws (2) (No. 12). Tighten drain plug and add oil through oil filter. Mounting bolt: 66.2w7.4 Nm (48.8w5.45 lb.ft.) Motor mating surface: Loctite 510 Swing machinery case: approx. 1.5 , (0.4 US.gall.) Swing machinery case: ASL800050 (approx. 110 cc)
30-44
3 4 2
5 RKP07600
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CONTROL VALVE
REMOVAL OF CONTROL VALVE Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground and switch off the engine.
4
1
Release residual pressures from all circuits. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). H Mark all pipes before removal.
1
2
1 - Disconnect pipes in the following sequence: servo control pipes (1), feed pipes (2), exhaust pipes (3), function pipes (4) and LS pipes (5). H Plug all holes so as to keep out impurities.
3
5
2 - Fit the unit with two eyebolts (6). (M8x1.25)
RKPA5810
3 - Hook the unit (7) to the hoisting equipment and slightly put the ropes under tension.
6
4 - Remove screws (8) (No. 3) and remove the distributor. Complete distributor: approx. 55 kg (121.2 lb.)
INSTALLATION OF CONTROL VALVE .
7
To install, reverse the removal procedure. RKPA5820
Distributor check screws: 190 Nm (140 lb.ft.) Distributor check screws: Loctite 262 1 - Check the level of the tank; start the engine to allow oil to circulate to all parts of the equipment. Switch off the engine and top up the oil level.
8
2 - Bleed air from all parts of the equipment. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»).
RKPB5700
PC75R-2
30-45
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
REVOLVING FRAME
REMOVAL OF REVOLVING FRAME Disconnect the lead from the negative (±) battery terminal. 1 - Remove the upper work equipment (For details, see «REMOVING UPPER WORK EQUIPMENT»). 2 - Remove the front hood. (For details, see «REMOVAL OF FRONT HOOD»). 3 - Remove the cabin and the seat. (For details, see «REMOVAL OF CABIN AND REMOVAL OF THE SEAT»).
1 2 2
4 - Remove the boom cylinder. (For details, see «REMOVAL OF BOOM CYLINDER»).
RKPA5751
5 - Disconnect all the lower tubes (2) from the swivel joint (1) and plug them. Also plug the fittings left on the joint. 6 - Remove the lower left-hand protective casing (3) of the revolving frame (4) to gain access to the retaining nuts of the LH area. 7 - Start the engine and swing the revolving frame (3) until a screw (5) in the rear extraction compartment of the track frame (6) has been centred.
5
7
6
8 - Remove the screw (5). 9 - Repeat the same operations for the other screws (No. 34).
RKPA5840
Leave two screws in position for reasons of safety, one at the front and one at the rear. 10 - Using the equipment A2 and A3 attach the revolving frame to a hoisting tackle and apply slight tension to the chains.
A3 A2
11 - Loosen and disengage the two screws, leaving them inserted in the bearing ring (7). 12 - Raise the revolving frame (4) slowly. H While raising the revolving frame, take great care not to damage the swivel joint.
4 RKPB0790
Revolving frame: 3300 kg (7270 lb.)
3 4 RKP07570
30-46
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
REVOLVING FRAME
INSTALLATION OF REVOLVING FRAME .
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Revolving frame attachment screws (without nut): Loctite 262 Revolving frame attachment screws: 314 Nm (231.4 lb.ft.)
8
H Align the two positions corresponding to the centering pins (8), then assemble. Sealant and swing circle platform gaskets: ASL800050 Internal swing circle grease: approx. 25 kg (55 lb.) H After connecting up all the hydraulic tubes, start the engine and move all parts of the equipment several times to bleed air from the circuits, while checking for leakages. H Switch off the engine and check level of the hydraulic oil.
7 RKPA5850
10 9 12 11
Installation Procedure In order to swing the revolving frame for centering the reference pins (8), the pinion-swing circle coupling: 1 - Disconnect the feed pipes (10), the drain line connection (11) and the brake release tube (12) from the swing motor (9). H Plug connections to avoid impurity entry.
RKPA5324
A1
2 - Connect tool A1 and slowly rotate the turret until correct centring is obtained. 3 - Insert the two screws (5) left in the swing circle (7) and secure them. 4 - Insert all the other screws (5). 5 - After having secured all the screws that joint the swing circle to the revolving frame, reconnect the delivery tubes (10) of the swing motor (9), and the brake release tube (12) and the drain line connection.
RKPA5800
6 - Detach the hoisting tackle.
PC75R-2
30-47
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
COUNTERWEIGHT
REMOVAL OF COUNTERWEIGHT Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground and switch off the engine. 1 - Remove the engine-hood. (For details, see «REMOVAL OF ENGINE HOOD»).
1
2 - Remove the engine-hood hook support (1). 3 - Remove the protective caps and firmly tighten the hoisting eyebolts (2). 4 - Attach the hoisting tackle and apply slight tension to the cables.
RKPB0970
5 - Using the tool B1, loosen the screws (3) and their safety washers. 6 - Remove the counterweight (4). Counterweight: 1050 kg (2313 lb.)
INSTALLATION OF COUNTERWEIGHT .
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
2
2
4 RKPB0960
Counterweight screws: Loctite 262 Counterweight screws: 580 Nm (427.5 lb.ft.) H Carefully check that the vertical positioning measurement «A» is 100w2 mm (3.94w0.08 in.) with respect to the revolving frame.
A
3
RKPB0980
30-48
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
SWING CIRCLE
REMOVAL OF SWING CIRCLE 1 - Remove the upper revolving frame. (For details, see «REMOVAL OF UPPER REVOLVING FRAME»).
3
S
2 - Completely remove all contaminated grease. 3 - Remove the screws (1) that secure the swing circle (2).
1
4 - Remove the swing circle (2) using the tool D1. Swing circle: 89 kg (196 lb.)
2 RKPA5860
INSTALLATION OF SWING CIRCLE H Before installing the swing circle, check the condition of the central gasket (3).
D1 2
For reasons of safety, when installing the swing circle, insert two screws into the front and back holes in the frame. .
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
S RKPA5870
Before attaching the swing circle, check that the area marked with an «S» is positioned on the right-hand side of the chassis. Attachment screws: Loctite 242 Attachment screws: 314 Nm (231.4 lb.ft.) Lubricating grease: approx. 25 kg (55 lb.)
PC75R-2
30-49
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRACK SHOES
REMOVAL OF TRACK SHOES 1 - Move the machine until the master pin (1) on the track shoe idler (2) is in its highest position. 2 - Slowly loosen the lubricator (3) to let out the grease and relieve track shoe tension. The grease contained in the track shoe stretching cylinder is under pressure and could cause serious injury to the operator. For this reason the valve should not be loosened by more than one turn. H If the grease does not flow out easily, move the machine backwards and forwards slowly.
3
RKPA5301
3 - Remove the master pin (1) using the tool C1. 4 - Raise the end-piece of the track-shoe (4) with a crane.
4
5 - Reverse the machine to remove the track shoe (4), then lay it out on the ground.
C1
6 - Force the boom down to raise the lower chassis and lift the track shoe away.
INSTALLATION OF TRACK SHOES .
RKPA5880
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
H Adjust the track shoe tension. (For details see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»).
1 - Rotate the revolving frame 90ë towards the side on which the track shoe is to be mounted. Force the boom down to raise the lower frame.
1 2
2 - Lay the track shoe out on the ground beneath the lower rollers. Let down the lower frame.
RKPA5890
3 - Attach the first joint to the sprocket assembly and move the machine forwards until the articulation is above the sprocket. 4 - Attach a crane to the end-piece of the track shoe in order to keep it raised.
4
5 - Insert the master pin (1) using the tool C1.
RKPA5900
30-50
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
SPROCKET ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL OF SPROCKET ASSEMBLY 1 - Remove the track shoe assembly. (For details, see «REMOVAL OF TRACK SHOE ASSEMBLY»). 2 - Turn the revolving frame 90ë towards the sprocket assembly to be removed. 3 - Force the boom down perpendicular to the ground and raise the lower chassis.
BLOCK BLOCCO
Insert safety blocks beneath the chassis. 4 - Remove the screws (1) and their washers. 5 - Remove the sprocket assembly (2).
RKP07870
Sprocket assembly: 35 kg (77.1 lb.)
INSTALLATION OF SPROCKET ASSEMBLY .
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Attachment screws: Loctite 262 Attachment screws: 163w24.5 Nm (119.6w18.1 lb.ft.)
PC75R-2
1 2 RKPA5910
30-51
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
REMOVAL OF TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR Completely lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground and switch off the engine. Release all residual pressure from all circuits. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). 1 - Remove the protection cover (1). 2 - Remove the driving wheel. (For details, see «REMOVAL OF THE DRIVING WHEEL»). 3 - Disconnect the 4 pipes (2) from the engine and then remove the 4 connections (3). H Plug all pipes to keep out impurity.
1 RKPA5410
4 - Pull out the screws (4) and remove the assembly (5). Travel assembly: 90 kg (198.3 lb.)
3
INSTALLATION OF THE TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR .
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
4
5
3
2
Check screws: Loctite 262 Check screws: 252w39.2 Nm (185.7w28.9 lb.ft.)
RKPA5341
H Bleed air form the travel motor (see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»).
30-52
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
DISASSEMBLY OF TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR 24 25
40
29
30
MOTOR
31 26
40
32 39
19 36 12
21
37 22 18
15 16
35
20 19 18
33 34
26
50
25
1
43
24
42 44
23 22
45
21 12
47 66
53
48 49
46
48
51
41
38 52
55 54
64
REDUCTION GEAR
RKP07550
69
73 60
68 67
17
73
56
74
74
76
76 69 72
14
71 10
3
6 58 57
62
70 75
8 4
59
2
65 9
61
7
5
1
63 RKP07560
PC75R-2
30-53
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
Washing the geared motor 1 - Wash the complete motor. H Close the holes of the hydraulic motor and install two M8 eye-bolts in the body of the pump so that they are placed diametrally opposite to each other.
M8
RKPA5920
2 - When washing, brush the unit so as to eliminate any trace of dust.
RKPA5930
2. Setting the geared motor 3 - Set the geared motor unit on the work bench M1.
M1
RKPA5940
4 - Bolt the unit to the revolving cradle on the work bench using two hex. socket bolts A.
A
RKPA5950
30-54
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
3. Draining gear oil
2
5 - Turn the unit upside down and partially extract the three plugs (2) form the cover (1). Turn the unit upside down again and remove the plugs (2) to drain the gear oil.
1
Reduction gear oil: approx. 1.7 , (0.45 US.gall)
RKPA5960
4. Removing cover
1
6 - Turn the unit upside down bringing the cover (1) to top side. Scribe match marks between the hub (3) and the cover (1) by using a paint marker.
3
RKPA5970
7 - Locate the gap of ring (4). Using a punch, make a mark on the hub (3) at a point about 20 mm (0.788 in.) from ring (4) end and at 7 mm (0.276 in.) from the surface of the hub (3).
Gap of ring Giunzione
Cover Coperchio
4
Ring Anello
anello 20
7 Ø2
3
Hub Corpo riduttore
RKPA5980
8 - Using an electric drill, make a 2 mm (0.079 in.) diameter hole at the punch mark as shown at point 7. H Make sure that the hole is parallel to the surface of the hub (3) and keep drilling until reaching the ring (4). H After drilling, wipe off chippings and cinders completely.
4
3 RKPA5990
PC75R-2
30-55
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
9 - Insert a steel rod into the drilled hole and push it in to make the front portion the ring (4) come out.
4
RKPA6000
10 - Pick the end portion of ring (4) and pull it out to remove the ring off the groove.
4
RKPA6010
11 - Tighten two (3/8") eyebolts into the plug holes (2) and remove the cover (1) using a piece of hoisting equipment. H If the O-ring (5) prevents lifting of the cover (1), put the hoisting ropes under tension and tap on the cover using a plastic mallet so that the cover will slide out without cocking.
1
RKPA6020
12 - Remove the O-ring (5) from the cover and dispose of it.
5
RKPA6030
30-56
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
5. Removing input gear
6
13 - Remove the snap ring (6) from the shaft (7).
RKPA6040
14 - Remove the input gear (8) from the first reduction, remove the shaft (7) the coupling (9) and the steel ball (10).
8
7
RKPA6050
15 - Turn the unit upside down and remove the screws (11). H If the brake valves of the motor (13) are to be disassembled too, loosen the plugs (12) before removing the screws (11).
13
12 11 RKPA6060
6. Removing rear flange 16 - Remove the motor (13) together with the O-rings (14). H Lift motor (13) straight up holding it with both hands to avoid dropping the valve plate (15) which is to remain attached to the motor.
13
14
RKPA6070
PC75R-2
30-57
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
17 - Remove the springs (16), the O-ring (17) and the pins (18).
18
RKPA6080
7. Removing parts from rear flange 18 - Remove the valve plate (15) from the motor (13). H To separate valve plate (15) from the motor (13), never use sharp cornered or pointed tools or the faces will be scratched and suffer serious damage. Gently slide the valve plate to one side whilst prising it.
13
15
RKPA6090
19 - Pull out the pins (19) and the ball bearing (20).
20
19
RKPA6100
8. Disassembling brake valves 20 - Remove the two plugs (12) of the brake valves.
12 RKPA6110
30-58
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
21 - Take out the springs (21), the spring housings (22) and the spools (23).
21
23 RKPA6120
22 - Remove the two plugs (24).
24 23 - From each plug opening (24), remove the springs (25) and the valves (26).
RKPA6130
26
RKPA6140
24 - Remove the O-rings (27) and (28) from the plugs (12) and (24) and dispose of them.
27
12
28
24 RKPA6150
PC75R-2
30-59
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
9. Disassembling pilot valve 25 - Remove the snap ring (29) of the pilot valve and discard it. Then, remove the stopper (30), spring (31) and valve (32). H Do not remove the snap ring (29) if valve (32) is not to be replaced; if the snap ring is removed, then it must be replaced. H If inverting the motor does not cause the valve the come out , carefully apply compressed air through the speed change port to remove it.
29
To ensure your safety, use a protective cover. RKPA6160
10. Disassembling plug 26 - Remove the plug (33). H Do not remove the plug (33) unless absolutely necessary. H When removing plug to clean the gates, pay particular attention not to drop the steel ball (34).
34 33
RKP07540
11. Disassembling parking brake 27 - Remove the piston (35) of the parking brake. H Carefully inject compressed air through the parking brake access hole to facilitate removal. To ensure your safety, apply a protective cover.
35
RKPA6170
28 - Remove the O-rings (36) and (37) from the piston (35) and dispose of them.
35
Do not reuse O-rings (36) and (37).
37 36 RKPA6180
30-60
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
12. Disassembling hydraulic motor 29 - Turn the geared motor by 90ë and drain the oil.
RKPA6190
30 - Slowly pull the cylinder block (38) off the motor shaft (41) together with the friction plates (39) and (40). H Before pulling, rock the cylinder block to and fro several times to facilitate the separation of piston shoes (42) from the sliding face (43).
38
41
RKPA6200
31 - Remove the piston kit (42) from the cylinder block (38) by lifting it together with the retainer plate (44). H If any piston or shoe is damaged, the entire kit must be replaced.
44
42
43 RKPA6210
32 - Remove each single piston (42) from the retainer plate (44) and the thrust ball (45) from the cylinder block (38).
42 45
RKPA6220
PC75R-2
30-61
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
33 - Remove the three dowel pins (46) of the thrust ball (45) from the cylinder block (38).
46
RKPA6230
13. Removing spring from cylinder block
48
M3
47
48
49 47
3 mm
34 - Using tool M3 and a press, remove the spring (47) and the washers (48) from the cylinder block (38) after picking the snap ring (49) out. H Do not remove the spring if it is not to be replaced. H Compress the spring just as much as needed to engage the snap ring (39) with the snap ring pliers (approx. 3 mm (0.118 in.)). H Protect the surface of the cylinder block to avoid any possible damage.
RKPA6700
14. Removing motor shaft
50
35 - Remove the swash plate (50) together with the thrust plate (43) from the motor shaft.
RKPA6240
36 - Separate the thrust plate (43) from the swash plate (50). H If the thrust plate is stuck to the swash plate due to thick oil between them, slide them apart.
50 43
RKP07530
30-62
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
37 - Remove the shaft (41) together with the ball bearing (51). H To remove the shaft (41), lightly kick the shaft end on the reduction gear side with a plastic hammer.
41
51
RKPA6250
38 - Remove the two pivots (52), pins (53), piston (54) and spring (55). H Carefully apply low-pressure compressed air to remove the units.
52
For your own safety, use a protective cover.
RKPA6260
15. Removing bearing from motor shaft 39 - Using tool M4 and a press, remove ball the bearing (51) from the shaft (41). H Do not remove the ball bearing (51) unless it is to be replaced. H Do not reuse the removed ball bearing.
51 M4
41
RKP07890
16. Removing planetary gears
56
40 - Turn the motor upside down, bringing the planetary gears to top side and remove the snap rings (57) and gears (58) from the shafts (56).
58 57
RKPA6270
PC75R-2
30-63
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
41 - Remove the distance pieces (59).
59
RKPA6280
17. Removing hold flange 42 - Install two clamps M2 between the hub (3) and the reduction gear support (60). Tighten the bolts into the respective threaded holes. H This clamping is necessary to prevent the hub from falling when removing the hold flange (61).
M2
RKPA6290
43 - Remove the three snap rings (62). H Make position match marks across the hold flange (61) and each snap ring (62) by using a paint marker. This is done to ensure that the parts are in their correct position when reassembled.
61
62 RKPA6300
44 - Loosen the three reamer bolts (63) securing the hold flange (61) to the reduction gear support. H Loctite 638 is used on screw threads of these bolts. When loosening them, turn the torque wrench back and forth to break the Loctite 638. Repeat this process until each bolt becomes loose enough to be run out by bare hand.
63
RKPA6310
30-64
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
18. Removing flange 45 - Remove the flange (61) from the reduction gear support (60). H Make match marks across hold flange (61) and reduction gear support (60) by using a paint marker. This to ensure that the parts are in their correct position when re-assembled.
61
The holes for reamer bolts (63) in the flange (61) are machined with the hold flange attached to the reduction gear support; if one of the parts is damaged, replace the entire assembly at the same time.
RKPA6320
19. Removing reduction gear support 46 - Remove the two clamps M2 applied at point (42) and after screwing two eye-bolts M9 into two opposing screw-holes, remove the reduction gear support (60) and the floating seal (64), the outer race of bearing (65) and the seal (66). H The removed floating seal must be disposed of.
M9
60
RKPA6330
47 - Remove the distance piece (67) and the O-ring (68).
67
68 RKPA6340
20. Removing ball bearings, gears and pins 48 - Remove the ball bearing (69) from the hub (3) by simultaneously taking out the pins (70) using a pin punch and a hammer. Through this process, the RV gear assembly is also removed. The RV gear assembly consists of gear A (71), gear B (72), crankshafts (56), tapered-roller bearings (65) and needle-roller bearings (73).
3 65 71 72 73
PC75R-2
70 69 56
RKP07520
30-65
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
H When removing ball bearing (69), move the pin punch 120ë at a time in order to keep the distortion of the ball bearing down to a minimum. H In order to prevent denting of the parts, place a rubber mat under the RV gear assembly. RV gear assembly can now be disassembled; do not remove needle-roller bearings (73) and distance pieces (75) from the crankshafts (56).
21. Removing ball bearing and distance piece 49 - Remove the ball bearing (69) still positioned in its seat by applying a pin punch to the distance piece (74) and hammering the punch. H Place a rubber mat under the RV gear assembly to prevent denting of parts.
3 74 69
RKP07510
22. Removing central seal 50 - Remove seal (66) from reduction gear support (60) and dispose of it.
66
RKP08090
51 - Remove floating seals (64) from the reduction gear support (60).
64
RKPA6350
30-66
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
23. Disassembling hold flange 52 - Remove the outer races of tapered-roller bearings (65) from the reduction gear support (60).
65 RKPA6360
24. Washing parts 53 - Wash all parts and dry them out using soft cloths. 54 - Protect all unpainted surfaces from oxidation by coating them with oil.
PC75R-2
30-67
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
ASSEMBLY OF TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR NOTES 1 - If any of the hub (3), reduction gear support (60), hold flange (61), distance piece (74), ball bearings (69) is replaced, adjust the ball bearing (69) preload. 2 - If any of the hub (3), reduction gear support (60), hold flange (61), RV gear assembly, bearings (65) is replaced, adjust the preload of tapered-roller bearings (65). 3 - For bearing preload adjustment, refer to the sections found at the end of assembly procedures. 4 - If all removed parts can be re-used in assembly due to their complying with the required tolerances, follow the assembly procedure below:
1. Hub 1 - Bolt hub (3) to the revolving cradle on the work bench M1.
3 RKPA6370
2 - Install the distance piece (74) into the hub (3).
74
RKPA6380
3 - Press the ball bearing (69) into the hub (3) by using an aluminium rod and hammer. H Shift the aluminium rod around the rim of bearing to keep it flat; tap around to prevent distortion and to keep the bearing flat.
69
RKPA6390
30-68
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
4 - Lightly grease the O-ring (68) and fit it into the groove in the hub (3).
68
Seal: ASL800050
RKPA6400
5 - Fit distance piece (67) to hub (3), holding it with both hands and lowering it slowly into position. H As necessary, tap around on distance piece (67) with a plastic hammer. H Be careful not to damage the O-ring (68) already in place.
67
RKPA6410
2. Reduction gear support 6 - Lightly grease the floating seals O-rings (64) and install them in the reduction gear support (60). H Separate the O-ring part of the floating seal and grease the seat; fit the O-ring again and make sure that it fits perfectly into the seat. Check that the floating seal is perfectly inserted into its seat.
64 RKPA6420
7 - Install the two M9 eye-bolts into the reduction gear support (60), lift the support with a crane and lower it into the hub (3).
M9
60
3
RKPA6430
PC75R-2
30-69
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
8 - Remove the two eye-bolts M9 and apply two clamps M2 to hold hub (3) and support (60) together. H Tighten the two clamps equally.
3
M2
60
RKPA6440
9 - Turn over the revolving cradle of work stand M1 and insert the outer races of the tapered-roller bearings (65).
65
RKPA6450
10 - Install the RV gear A (71) into the hub (3).
71
RKPA6460
11 - Install the crankshafts (56) complete with needle roller bearings (74), distance pieces (76) and bearings (65) into the outer races of the tapered roller bearings.
65
73
74
76
RKPA6470
30-70
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
12 - Install RVgear B (72) into the hub (3), making sure to align the locating holes.
72
RKPA6480
13 - Apply gear oil to the pins (70) and insert them in between the RV gear assembly and the hub.
70
Pins: reduction gear oil.
RKPA6490
14 - Press ball bearing (69) into the hub by using an aluminium pin punch and a hammer. H Shift the pin punch around the bearing to keep it flat; tap around to prevent distortion and to keep the bearing flat.
69
RKP07900
3. Hold flange 15 - Lubricate the seat of the hold flange (61) and install it into the hub (3) by centring the inner race of the ball bearing (69); if necessary, hammer the hold flange lightly with a plastic hammer. Flange seat: ASL800040 H Install the hold flange in the same position as before disassembly, referring to the marks made during disassembly.
61 RKPA6500
PC75R-2
30-71
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
4. Tightening reamer bolts 16 - Thoroughly remove grease from the reamer bolts (63), apply adhesive to the threaded portion and a thin coat of anti-seize lubricant to the shank. Screw the three reamer bolts (63) until the hold flange (61) completely enters in the ball bearing (69).
63
Threaded portion: Loctite 638 Anti-seize lubricant: ASL800040
61
RKPA6510
17 - Tighten the three reamer bolts (63) using a dynamometric wrench. H Tighten a little at a time increasing the torque so that the tightening force is evenly distributed among the bolts. Final torque: 42w6.5 kgm (303.8w47 lb.ft.)
63
RKPA6520
18 - Install the outer races of the tapered roller bearings (65) into the hold flange (61).
65
61 RKPA6530
19 - Install the snap rings (62) into the snap ring grooves in hold flange (61). H If any of the parts needing preload adjustment is replaced, see adjustment procedure illustrated in the end sections.
62
RKPA6540
30-72
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
20 - Install the three distance pieces (59) onto each crankshaft (56).
59 56
RKPA6550
6. Planetary gear 21 - Install the three gears (58) to the crankshafts (56). H Install the gears in the same angular position defined by the matching marks, as illustrated here.
58
Position matching
Contrassegni marks
61 RKPA6560
RKP07910
22 - Install the three snap rings (57) into the snap ring grooves in the crankshafts (56).
57
RKPA6570
7. Seals 23 - Turn over the unit under assembly, apply grease to the lip portion of seal and to the outer part of seal (66); force it into the bore of the reduction gear support (60) by driving with the retainer M5 and hammer.
66
M5
60
Seal: ASL800050
RKP10690
PC75R-2
30-73
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
8. Motor shaft 24 - Install the ball bearing (51) onto the motor shaft (41). H Heat ball bearing (51) by keeping it immersed in oil bath held at 100w10ëC (212w50ëF) for 10 minutes. H Be sure that the inner race sits on the shoulder.
51 41
RKPA6580
25 - Lubricate the pivots (52), pins (53) and piston (54) and insert them into the reduction gear support (60).
54
Pins, piston pivot: ASL800050
RKPA6590
26 - Turn over the unit by 90ë, lubricate the outer race of bearing (51) and slowly insert it into the reduction gear support (60).
51
Bearing: ASL800040 H Take care not to scratch or damage the lip portion of seal (66) with the splined end of shaft (41).
41
RKPA6600
27 - Lubricate the splines of shaft (41) and the swash plate (50) where matching the surface of reduction gear support.
50
Shaft and swash plate: ASL800040 Insert the swash plate into the reduction gear support (60). H Make sure that the locating pivot of the reduction gear support centers the grooves of the swash plate.
RKPA6610
30-74
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
9. Cylinder block
48
28 - Insert washer (48), spring (47), the second washer (48) and the snap ring (49) into the cylinder block.
47
38 RKPA6620
29 - Place the block under a press and using a retainer M3 centred on the outer washer (48), press the spring until the snap ring groove becomes cleared. Fit the snap ring. H Protect the surface of the cylinder block to prevent any damage.
M3
49
RKPA6630
10. Hydraulic motor parts 30 - Insert the three dowel pins (46) into the pin holes of the cylinder block (38). Install the thrust ball (45) onto the dowel pins (46).
42
46
45
44
31 - Insert the 9 pistons (42) into the retainer plate (44) and immerse the sub-assembly in hydraulic oil.
38 32 - Install the sub-assembly consisting of pistons and retainer-plate into the cylinder block (38). H Check that the retainer plate (44) fits snugly to the thrust ball (45).
RKPA6640
44
45
38
RKPA6650
PC75R-2
30-75
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
33 - Install the complete cylinder block to the motor shaft (41).
41
RKPA6660
11. Parking brake 34 - Fit the friction unit into the grooves of the cylinder block (38) by installing first a friction plate (40) then a mating plate (39), the second friction plate (40) and then the final mating plate. H Immerse the friction plates (40) in hydraulic oil before fitting them.
40
39
RKPA6670
35 - Lubricate O-rings (37) and (36) and fit them onto the piston (35). Fit the piston (35) into the reduction gear support (60) taking care not to damage the seals.
35
Seals: ASL800050 H If necessary, tap all around the edge with a plastic mallet.
37 36
60
RKPA6680
12. Braking valve (in rear flange) 36 - Grease the O-rings (28), the springs (25) and the valves (26) and fit each single part into the plugs (24). Seals, springs and valves: ASL800050
24
28
RKPA6690
30-76
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
37. Insert the complete valve assemblies into the rear flange (13). H Fit the valve assemblies preventing valves (26) and springs (25) from cocking.
13
RKPA6710
38 - Tighten valve plugs (24). Plugs: 13 kgm (94 lb.ft.)
24 RKPA6720
39 - Lubricate the spools (23) and insert them into the rear flange (13).
13
23
RKPA6730
40 - Lightly lubricate the O-rings (27) and fit them onto the plugs (12). O-rings: ASL800050
12
27 RKPA6740
PC75R-2
30-77
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
41 - Grease and fit springs (21) and spring retainers (22) into plugs (12); screw the two assemblies into the rear flange (13).
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
13
Springs and spring retainers: ASL800050
12 RKPA6750
42 - Tighten valve plugs (12). Plugs: 36 kgm (260.4 lb.ft.)
12 RKPA6760
13. Rear flange
32
43 - Lubricate the valve (32) with hydraulic oil and insert it into the rear flange (13).
RKPA6770
44 - Fit the spring (31) and the stopper (30) into valve (32) and finally install the ring (29) that holds the subassembly together. H The ring (29) must be a new one.
30
29
RKPA6780
30-78
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
45 - Lubricate the ball bearing (20) and fit it into the rear flange (13).
20
RKPA6790
46 - Insert the pins (19) into the rear flange (13).
19
RKPA6800
47 - Lightly grease the surface of the valve plate (15) and fit it to the rear flange (13) taking care to centre the pins (19).
15
19
RKPA6810
48 - Fit the O-rings (14) and (17) into the grooves provided in the reduction gear support (60). H Do not lubricate seals.
17
14 RKPA6820
PC75R-2
30-79
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
49 - Fit the pins (18) into the reduction gear support (60) and pour hydraulic oil in the support. Hydraulic oil: 0.55
18
, (0.145 US.gall)
RKPA6830
50 - Generously apply grease to the springs (16) and insert them into the rear flange (13). Turn the rear flange (13) upside down and fit it to the reduction gear support (60) so that it centres the pins (18).
13
18 16
RKPA6840
51 - Fasten the subassembly with the screws (11). Fastening screws: 5.9w1 kgm (42.7w7.23 lb.ft.)
11 RKPA6850
52 - Fasten the two valve plugs (12). Valve plugs: 36w4 kgm (260.4w29 lb.ft.)
12
RKPA6860
30-80
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
53 - Lock the valve plugs (24).
24
Valve plugs: 13w1.5 kgm (94w10.8 lb.ft.)
RKPA6870
15. Input gear 54 - Install the coupling (9) and the input gear (8) onto the motor shaft (41). H The teeth of input gear (8) should mesh smoothly with the gears (58); if not, it means that the subassembly is improperly reassembled. In such case, check for the cause.
8
RKPA6880
55 - Fit the snap ring (6) to lock the input gear (8) into position. Grease the steel ball (10) and position it in the shaft (7). Steel ball: ASL800050
6 8
RKPA6890
16. Cover
5
56 - Pour gear oil into the hub (3). Oil for hub: 1.7
, (0.45 US.gall)
57 - Grease the O-ring (5) and fit it on the cover (1). O-ring: ASL800050
1 RKPA6900
PC75R-2
30-81
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL GEARED MOTOR
58 - Fit the cover (1) on the reduction gear support (60) matching the marks made during disassembly. H After positioning the cover, force it in lightly by tapping with a plastic hammer on and around its rim.
1
RKPA6910
59 - Lock cover in place by installing ring (4).
4
RKPA6920
60 - Apply sealant to the plugs (2), run them into the cover (1) and tighten.
2
Plugs: ASL800060 Plugs: 4w1.5 kgm (29w10.8 lb.ft.)
1
RKPA6930
61 - Remove the complete geared motor from the cradle of the work bench M1.
M1
RKPA6940
30-82
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
BALL BEARING PRELOAD
ADJUSTING BALL BEARING PRELOAD 1 - Fit the hub (3) onto the tool M7 for adjusting the preload of the main bearing (69); press fit the ball bearing (69) into the hub, install the flange of the tool and tighten the nut. Nut: 4 kgm (17 lb.ft.)
69
M7 RKPA6950
2 - Insert a depth micrometer through the hole provided in tool M7 in order to determine value «A». Since «B» is a known dimension of tool M7 , clearance of bearing can be determined as follows:
Micrometer Micrometro
M7 B A
C = A ± B where A =measured value B =tool dimension C =clearance of preloaded bearing
C
RKP07920
3 - Check dimension D of the hold flange (61): a - If measured dimension D is smaller than the required value C, lower the surface E of the hold flange (61).
D 61
E
b - If measured dimension D matches the required value C, use the flange as it is. c - If measured dimension D is greater than the required value C, replace the complete reduction gear support assembly. H Dimension D of the new hold flange (61) allows for adjustment.
RKP07930
4 - Remove tool M7 from the reduction gear support and proceed with the usual assembly procedure.
M7
RKPA6960
PC75R-2
30-83
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
AXIAL CLEARANCE ON TAPERED ROLLER BEARINGS
ADJUSTING AXIAL CLEARANCE ON TAPERED ROLLER BEARINGS 1 - Apply retainer M6 to the outer races of tapered roller bearings (65) on the crankshafts (56); lightly hammer the retainer to facilitate the insertion of the RV gears (71) and (72) into the reduction gear support (69).
M6
RKPA6970
2 - Fit the least thick snap rings (62) in the grooves provided in the hold flange (61). H Snap rings (12) come in 12 different types of thickness, each one varying by 0.05 mm (0.002 in.)from the other.
62
3 - Using the thickness gauge M10, measure the clearance between the snap rings (62) and the tapered roller bearings (65). 4 - Determine whether the thickness of the snap ring is within the tolerances required, as follows: MAX= thickness gauge thickness + snap ring thickness
RKPA6980
MIN = thickness gauge thickness + snap ring thickness ± 0.05 mm (0.002 in.) 5 - Select the suitable snap ring by choosing the correct thickness among the values reported in the table below: Group
Dimension t (mm)
A
Over 1.90 and up to 1.95
B
Over 1.95 and up to 2.00
C
Over 2.00 and up to 2.05
D
Over 2.05 and up to 2.10
E
Over 2.10 and up to 2.15
F
Over 2.15 and up to 2.20
G
Over 2.20 and up to 2.25
H
Over 2.25 and up to 2.30
I
Over 2.30 and up to 2.35
J
Over 2.35 and up to 2.40
K
Over 2.40 and up to 2.45
L
Over 2.45 and up to 2.50
M10
RKPA6990
RKPA7000
30-84
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
IDLER AND RECOIL SPRING ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL OF IDLER AND RECOIL SPRING ASSEMBLY 1 - Position the connecting pin (1) of the track shoe above the idler (2). 2 - Slowly loosen the grease nipple (3) to let the grease out and release the track-shoe tension. The grease contained in the track-shoe idler is under pressure and could cause serious injury to the operator. For this reason the valve should not be loosened for more than one turn. H If the grease does not run out easily, slowly move the machine backwards and forwards.
1 2 RKPA5890
Rest the work equipment on the ground and switch off the engine. 3 - Remove the connecting pin (1) using the tool C1. H While taking the track shoe to pieces, support the part of the shoe that encircles the idler by placing a block beneath the shoe ribbing.
3 7
4 - Lay the track shoe out on the ground.
6
5 - Using the tool C2, put a sling around the group (4) and draw it out of the track-frame guides (5). Complete group: 75 kg (165.2 lb.) 6 - Unscrew and take out the screws (6) and remove the cylinder (7). H Take care not to damage the grease nipple (3).
RKPA7020
7 - Set the group down firmly on a flat surface, support the track shoe idler (2) and remove the screws (8) that join the track shoe idler group (4) to the recoil spring group (9). H Before removing the screws (8) mark the connecting bracket (10) and the spacers.
C2
5
4
INSTALLATION OF IDLER AND RECOIL SPRING ASSEMBLY RKPA7030
.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. H Adjust the tension of the track shoe. (For details see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»).
8
2
10
9
4 RKPA7040
PC75R-2
30-85
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
IDLER
DISASSEMBLY OF IDLER H When dismantling the idlers, fit all new seals. H Remove the cap (10) and drain the oil.
5
4
Track shoe idler: approx. 600 , (158.4 US.gall.)
1
3
1 - Detach the recoil spring assembly (2) from the supports (1) of the idler. H Before removing the screws (3), mark the joint support (4) and the spacers (5).
Riferimenti MARKS
2 - Take away the pins (6).
2
3 - Using a press, extract the pin (7) and remove the supports (1) and the lateral seals (8).
5 RKPA7041
4 - Remove the bushings (9).
ASSEMBLY OF IDLER .
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
H Use a press for the final assembly. H Line up the holes and the supports before inserting the pins.
10
1
1 6
6
7
1 - Fill up with oil and replace the cap (10). Track shoe idler: 600 cc Oil cap: 55w5 Nm (40.5w3.7 lb.ft.)
8
8 9
30-86
9
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
RECOIL SPRING GROUP AND CYLINDER
DISMANTLING AND RE-ASSEMBLING THE RECOIL SPRING GROUP AND CYLINDER 1. Recoil spring Disassembly
F E1
1 - Remove the welded base (1).
2
2 - Position the group (2) beneath the press and centre the tool E1. The spring is mounted under a high installed load, so make sure that the group is wellcentred. 3 - Apply pressure and, once the spring (3) is fully compressed, remove the safety pin (4) and the ring nut (5).
RKP07990
4 - Slowly reduce pressure to free the spring.
A
H Free spring length: 233 mm (9.18 in.) 5 - Remove rod (6), spring (3) and plate (7).
Assembly .
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
H Check the total length of the group. . Total length «A»: 245w1 mm (9.653w0.0394 in.) . Spring pre-loading: 4000 kg . Length of spring when pre-loaded: 203 mm (8 in.) H Check that the base (1) is tightly welded.
RKP07940
4 3 5
2. Cylinder Disassembly
6
1
7
1 - Remove the lubricator (1) and the washer (2). 2 - Draw the piston (3) out of the cylinder (4). RKP07950
3 - Remove the ring (5). 4 - Remove the seal (6) from the piston (3).
4
Assembly .
6
To re-assemble, reverse the removal procedure. Piston and sealants: ASL800050.
5 3
1 2
RKP07960
PC75R-2
30-87
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRACK ROLLER
REMOVAL OF TRACK ROLLER 1 - Slowly unscrew the lubricator (1) to let out the grease and relieve tension on the track shoe. The grease contained in the track shoe cylinder is pressurised and could cause serious injury to the operator. For this reason the valve should not be loosened by more than one turn. H If the grease does not flow out easily, move the machine backwards and forwards slowly.
1
2 - Loosen the screws (2) that hold the idlers (4). 3 - Rotate the revolving frame 90ë towards the removal side. Force the boom down to raise the lower chassis (3).
RKPA5300
4 - Remove the track roller (4).
INSTALLATION OF TRACK ROLLER .
4
2 2
To install, reverse the removal procedure. RKPA5291
H With the lower chassis (3) raised, install the idlers (4) and lightly fasten the attachment screws (2). Idler attachment screws: Loctite 262 H Slowly let down the lower frame (3) until the idlers (4) rest completely on the track shoe and then tighten the screws (2) firmly. Idler attachment screws: 118 Nm (87 lb.ft.) H Adjust track-shoe tension. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»).
3 4 RKPA7060
30-88
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CARRIER ROLLER
REMOVAL OF CARRIER ROLLER 1 - Slowly unscrew the lubricator (1) to let out the grease and relieve tension on the track shoe. The grease contained in the track shoe stretching cylinder is under pressure and could cause serious injury to the operator. For this reason the valve should not be loosened by more than one turn. H If the grease does not flow out easily, move the machine backwards and forwards slowly.
1
Lower the work equipment to the ground and switch off the engine.
RKPA5300
2 - Raise the track shoe (2) to a height that leaves the idler (3) free. For reasons of safety, position some blocks (4).
2
3 - Loosen the retaining screw (5) and remove the carrier roller.
INSTALLATION OF CARRIER ROLLER .
4
4
3
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
RKPA7070
1 - Adjust track shoe tension (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). 2 - Before finally securing the retaining screws, lower the track shoe (2) and check that the idler (3) is perfectly centred. Screw: 580 Nm (427.5 lb.ft.)
5 3 RKPA7080
PC75R-2
30-89
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
R.H. PPC VALVE (BOOM-BUCKET)
REMOVAL OF R.H. PPC VALVE (BOOM-BUCKET) Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground and switch off the engine, and remove the starting key. Release residual pressures from all circuits. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). Disconnect the lead from the negative (±) battery terminal.
1 - Remove screws (1) and remove cover (2) 2 - Disconnect connectors (3), remove screws (4) and remove the dashboard (5).
1
3 2 1 5
4 RKPB1190
3 - Remove screws (6) and armrest (7). 4 - Remove retaining screws (8) (në 3) of R.H. dashboard (9). H To remove the inside screw, lower the seat and push it right back.
7 9 8
5 - Disconnect the cath (10) from the R.H. dashboard (9).
6 RKPB1200
6 - Move backward the R.H. dashboard. Disconnect hoses (11) (në 6) from the PPC valve (12) and plug them to prevent entry of impurities. H Mark the position to avoid errors during assembly.
13
10 12
7 - Remove screws (13) and remove the PPC valve (12). If there is a slack on the control lever, adjust the unit (See «20: TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS Adjustment of manual control slacks»)
11
RKPB1210
30-90
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
R.H. PPC VALVE (BOOM-BUCKET)
INSTALLATION OF R.H. PPC VALVE (BOOM-BUCKET) .
T
To install, reverse the removal procedure. H Check the positions carefully when reconnecting the tubes. P - Pressure T - Unload P1 - Arm opening P4 - R.H. swing P2 - Arm closing P3 - L.H. swing
P2
P
P4 P3
P1 RKPA3120
1 - Start the engine to circulate the oil and check the seals.
PC75R-2
30-91
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
L.H. PPC VALVE (ARM-SWING)
REMOVAL OF L.H. PPC VALVE (ARM-SWING) Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground and switch off the engine. Release residual pressures from all circuits. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). Disconnect the lead from the negative (±) battery terminal.
1 - Remove the knob (1) and loosen the heating control fixing nut (2)
3
2 - Disconnect the catch (3) from the L.H. dashboard (4).
2
1
4
RKPB1220
3 - Remove the arm rest (6) fixing screws (5). 4 - Remove screws (7) and L.H. dashboard (4). H To remove the inside screw, lower the seat and push it right back.
5
6
4 7 RKPB1230
5 - Disconnect the six tubes (8) from the PPC valve (9) and plug them to prevent entry of impurities. H Mark the positions to avoid errors during assembly.
10
9
6 - Remove screws (10) and remove PPC valve (9). If there is a slack on the control lever, adjust the unit (See «20: TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS Adjustment of manual control slacks»)
8 RKPB1240
30-92
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
L.H. PPC VALVE (ARM-SWING)
INSTALLATION OF PPC VALVE (ARM-SWING) .
T
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
P2
P H Check the positions carefully when reconnecting the tubes. P - Pressure T - Unload P1 - Arm opening P4 - R.H. swing P2 - Arm closing P3 - L.H. swing
P4 P3
P1 RKPB1290
1 - Start the engine to circulate the oil and check the seals.
PC75R-2
30-93
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
BLADE PPC VALVE
REMOVAL OF BLADE PPC VALVE Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground and switch off the engine. Release residual pressures from all circuits. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). 1 - Remove the cabin (For details, see «REMOVAL OF CABIN»). 2 - Remove the casing (1) from right-hand manual control support. 3 - Disconnect the tubes (2) and (3) and plug them. H Make an identifying mark on the pipes to avoid mixing them up during installation.
1 4 4
5
2
3 RKPA7090
4 - Remove the screw (4) and the PPC valve (5).
INSTALLATION OF BLADE PPC VALVE .
To install, reverse the removal procedure. 1 - Start the engine to circulate the oil. 2 - Bleed air from the blade cylinder. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»).
30-94
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TRAVEL PEDAL CONTROL
REMOVAL OF TRAVEL PEDAL CONTROL .
Rotate the turret by 90ë to the left.
2
Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground and switch off the engine.
3
Release residual pressures from all circuits. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). 1 - Pull out the screws (1) and remove pedals (2) and levers (3).
5
1 RKPA7110
2 - Remove the bottom left casing (4). 3 - Disconnect the pipes (6) (No. 6) from the pedal control. H Make an identifying mark on the pipes to avoid mixing them up during installation. 4 - Remove the side connections (7) (No. 2) from the pedal control.
4
5 - Pull out the screws (8) and remove the pedal control (5). RKP07500
INSTALLATION OF TRAVEL PEDAL CONTROL .
6
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6 7
H Before proceeding to the final locking of pedals and levers, check the centring of shifting and the alignment in the neutral position.
RKPA7120
To equalise shifting, shift the lever (9). 1 - Start the engine to circulate the oil. 2 - Bleed air form the travel motors (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»).
5 8
8
9 RKPA7130
PC75R-2
30-95
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
1st BOOM SWING PEDAL CONTROL
REMOVAL OF 1st BOOM SWING PEDAL CONTROL .
Rotate the turret by 90ë to the left. Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground and switch off the engine. Release residual pressures from all circuits. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»).
1 - Remove the bottom left cover (1).
1
2 - Disconnect the pipes (2) (No. 4 tubes) from the pedal control. H Place an identifying mark on the pipes to avoid mixing them up during installation.
RKP07970
3 - Remove the connections (3) from the pedal control. 4 - Pull out the screws (4) and remove the pedal control (5) with the operation pedal (6).
3
INSTALLATION OF 1st BOOM SWING PEDAL CONTROL .
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
2
1 - Start the engine to circulate the oil. 2 - Bleed air from the front boom swing cylinder. (See «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»).
RKPA7140
6
5
4 RKPA7150
30-96
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
BOOM CYLINDER (For 1-piece boom)
REMOVAL OF BOOM CYLINDER (For 1-piece boom) Extend the arm fully and open the bucket completely. Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground
2
1 - Put a sling around the cylinder (1). 2 - Switch off the engine, release pressure in the cylinder by moving the RH PPC valve lever several times. 3 - Remove the screw (2) and draw out the pin (3).
3 4
4 - Start the engine to retract the piston (4).
1
5 - Lower the cylinder (1) until it rests on a stand «A». H To hold the piston rod in its fully retracted position tie it with wire.
RKPA7160
6 - Switch off the engine and release any residual hydraulic pressures. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»).
1
7 - Disconnect the tubes (5-6) and plug them. Also plug the holes in the safety valve to avoid entry of impurities. 8 - Remove pipe (7) and plug the cylinder port and the pipe to keep out impurities.
A
9 - Remove the screw (8) and safety valve (9).
RKPA7170
10 - Remove screw (10) and draw out the pin (11). 11 - Remove cylinder (1).
INSTALLATION OF BOOM CYLINDER (For 1-piece boom) .
9
8
7
To install, reverse the removal procedure. H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance (distributed on both sides of the cylinder rod) until a clearance of 1 ± 2 mm (0.0394 ± 0.0788 in.) is obtained.
5 6 RKPB1042
When aligning the positions between hole and pin, let the engine run at minimum idling. Do not insert fingers into the hole to check the alignment. Inside bushings : ASL800050
.
H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance (distributed on both sides of the piston rod) until a clearance of 0.5 ± 1 mm (0.0197 ± 0.0394 in.) is obtained. Start the engine and bleed air from the cylinder. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). H After bleeding the air, check the oil level in the tank.
PC75R-2
10
11 RKPA7180
30-97
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
BOOM CYLINDER (For 2-piece boom)
REMOVAL OF BOOM CYLINDER (For 2-piece boom) 1 - Fully extend the front work equipment, raise the boom and 2-piece boom and position a supporting stand (A) between them. H The stand should be 1.60 m (63.04 in.) high. 2 - Manoeuvre the arm until the bucket is resting on the ground. Switch off the engine.
A
RKPA7200
3 - Put a sling round the RH cylinder (1) of the 2-piece boom and remove the self-locking nut (2), the screw (3) and the adjustment to a given clearance (4).
1
1
4
4
2 5 3
5
RKPA7210
4 - Slide off the pin (5) that connects the RH cylinder (1) to the 2-piece boom, until the piston rod is completely disconnected. 5 - Start the motor and retract the RH cylinder piston.
6
H To secure the piston rod in this position, tie it with wire and switch off the engine.
1
6 - Disconnect the tubes (6) from the RH cylinder (1) and plug them.
7
7 - Slide out the pin (7) until the cylinder (1) is free and remove it.
RKPA7220
8 - Put the boom cylinder in a sling. 9 - Slide the pin (7) out until the boom cylinder piston rod (8) is disconnected. H To hold the piston rod it its fully retracted position, tie it with wire and switch off the engine.
8
10 - Start the engine and retract the piston. 11 - Lower the cylinder (8) and rest it on a stand (B).
7
B RKPA7230
30-98
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
BOOM CYLINDER (For 2-piece boom)
12 - Disconnect the tubes (9) and (10) and plug them. Also plug hole in the safety valve (11) to prevent impurities from entering. 13 - Remove pipe (12) and plug the cylinder port and the pipe (12) to keep out impurities. 14 - Remove the screw (13) and take out safety valve (11)
13
11
12
15 - Remove the screws (14) and take out the pin (15).
9 10
16 - Remove the cylinder.
RKPB1043
INSTALLATION OF THE BOOM CYLINDER (For 2-piece boom) .
14
8
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Self-locking nut: 118 Nm (87 lb.ft.)
15 RKPA7240
Inside bushings: ASL800050. When aligning the positions between hole and pin, run the engine at minimum idling. Do not insert fingers in the holes to check the alignment. H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance (distributed on both sides of the piston rod) until a clearance of (0.0197 ± 0.0394 in.) is obtained. H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance (distributed on both sides of the cylinder) until a clearance of (0.0197 ± 0.0394 in.) is obtained. .
Start the engine and bleed the air from the cylinders (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). H After bleeding the air, check the level of the oil tank.
PC75R-2
30-99
2nd BOOM CYLINDERS
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
REMOVAL OF 2nd BOOM CYLINDERS 1 - Fully extend the front work equipment, raise the boom and 2-piece boom and position a supporting stand (A) between them. H The stand should be 1.60 m (63.04 in.) high. 2 - Manoeuvre the arm until the bucket is resting on the ground. Switch off the engine.
A
RKPA7200
3 - Put a sling round the RH cylinder (1) of the 2-piece boom and remove the self-locking nut (2), the screw (3) and the adjustment to a given clearance (4).
1
1
4
4
2 5 3
5
RKPA7210
4 - Slide off the pin (5) that connects the RH cylinder (1) to the 2-piece boom, until the piston rod is completely disconnected. 5 - Start the motor and retract the RH cylinder piston. H To hold the rod in its fully retracted position, tie it with wire and switch off the engine.
6
1
6 - Disconnect the tubes (6) from the RH cylinder (1) and plug them. 7 - Slide out the pin (7) to free the cylinder (1) and remove it.
7 RKPA7220
8 - Put the boom cylinder in a sling. 9 - Slide the pin (7) out to disconnect the boom cylinder piston rod (8). 10 - Start the engine and retract the piston. H To hold the rod in its fully retracted position, tie it with wire and switch off the engine.
8
11 - Lower the cylinder and rest it on a stand (B).
7
B RKPA7230
30-100
PC75R-2
2nd BOOM CYLINDERS
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
12 - Repeat the procedure from points 3-7 to remove the LH cylinder of the 2-piece boom.
6
9
7
RKPA7250
INSTALLATION OF 2nd BOOM CYLINDERS .
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Self-locking nut: 118 Nm (87 lb.ft.) Inside bushings: ASL800050. When aligning the positions between hole and pin, run the engine at minimum idling. Do not insert fingers in the holes to check the alignment. H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance (distributed on both sides) until a clearance of 0.5 ± 1 mm (0.0197 ± 0.0394 in.) is obtained for each cylinder. H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance (distributed on both sides of the cylinder) until a clearance of 0.5 ± 1 mm (0.0197 ± 0.0394 in.) is obtained.
.
Start the engine and bleed the air from the cylinders (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). H After bleeding the air, check the level of the oil tank.
PC75R-2
30-101
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ARM CYLINDER
REMOVAL OF ARM CYLINDER Open the front work equipment completely, then raise it and place a supporting stand between the boom and the 2-piece boom. H The stand should be 1.60 m (63.04 in.) high. 1 - Manoeuvre the bucket until its teeth are resting on the ground, together with the arm. 2 - Put a sling around the cylinder (1).
A
3 - Switch off the engine, release pressure in the cylinder by moving the LH PPC valve lever several times. 4 - Remove the screw (2) and draw out the pin (3).
RKPA7260
5 - Start the engine to retract the piston (4). H To hold the piston in its fully retracted position, tie the rod with wire. 6 - Switch off the engine and release any residual hydraulic pressures. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»).
5 1 3
4
7 - Disconnect the tubes (5) and plug them. If a safety valve has been installed, disconnect the tubes (6-7) from the valve. 8 - Remove the screw (8) and draw out the pin (9).
2 RKPA7050
9 - Lift out the cylinder (1).
INSTALLATION OF ARM CYLINDER .
To install, reverse the removal procedure. H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance (distributed on both sides of the piston rod) until a clearance of 1 ± 2 mm (0.0394 ± 0.0788 in.) is obtained.
7
6
When aligning the positions between hole and pin, let the engine run at minimum idling. Do not insert fingers into the hole to check the alignment.
RKPB1052
Inside bushings: ASL800050
.
H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance (distributed on both sides of the cylinder) until a clearance of 0.5 ± 1 mm (0.0197 ± 0.0394 in.) is obtained. Start the engine and bleed air from the cylinder. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). H After bleeding the air, check the oil level in the tank.
1
9
8
RKPA7010
30-102
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
BUCKET CYLINDER
REMOVAL OF BUCKET CYLINDER Extend the arm fully and open the bucket completely. Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground
4
1 - Switch off the engine and release pressure in the cylinder by moving the RH PPC valve lever several times.
2
2 - Remove the ring nut (2) and draw out the pin (3). 3 - Switch off the engine and retract the piston rod (4). H To hold the piston rod in its fully retracted position, tie it with wire.
3 RKPA7690
4 - Switch off the engine and release any residual hydraulic pressures. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»).
6
7
5 - Disconnect the hoses (5) and plug them. Also plug the holes of the rigid tubes to avoid entry of impurities.
1
6 - Put a sling around the cylinder (1). 7 - Remove the screw (6) and draw out the pin (7). 8 - Lift out the cylinder (1).
INSTALLATION OF BUCKET CYLINDER .
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5
RKPA7270
5 6 7
H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance (distributed on both sides of the piston rod) until a clearance of 1 ± 2 mm (0.0394 ± 0.0788 in.) is obtained. When aligning the positions between hole and pin, do not insert fingers into the hole to check the alignment.
RKPA7280
Inside bushings: ASL800050 H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance (distributed on both sides of the cylinder) until a clearance of 0.5 ± 1 mm (0.0197 ± 0.0394 in.) is obtained. .
Start the engine and bleed air from the cylinder. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). H After bleeding the air, check the oil level in the tank.
PC75R-2
30-103
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
BOOM SWING CYLINDER
REMOVAL OF BOOM SWING CYLINDER 1 - Swing the boom to the right to extend the cylinder fully. 2 - Swing the revolving frame 45ë and rest the work equipment on the ground. 3 - Switch off the engine and move the PPC valve several times to release all residual pressures.
1
4 - Remove the RH front guard (1) from the revolving frame (2).
2
5 - Disconnect the tubes (3) from the cylinder and plug them. Also plug the flanges (4) of the cylinder (5).
RKP07980
6 - Disconnect the lubricator tube (6). 7 - Place a block beneath the cylinder head to prevent the edge of the frame making dents in the piston rod. Also place a support beneath the cylinder.
5 4
4
8 - Remove the screw (7), draw out the pin (8) and detach the piston rod from its support (9). 9 - Remove the screws (10) and draw out the stop (11) and the pin (12).
3
10 - Slide the cylinder out partially from the front and, as soon as possible, put it in a sling and lift it off. H During this operation take great care not to dent the piston rod.
RKPA5491
INSTALLATION OF BOOM SWING CYLINDER .
7
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
8
H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance (distributed on both sides of the piston) until a clearance of 1 ± 2 mm (0.0394 ± 0.0788 in.) is obtained. When aligning the positions between hole and pin, let the engine run at minimum idling. Do not insert fingers into the hole to check the alignment. Inside bushings: ASL800050 H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance (distributed on both sides of the cylinder) until a clearance of 0.5 ± 1 mm (0.0197 ± 0.0394 in.) is obtained. .
Start the engine and bleed air from the cylinder. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). H After bleeding the air, check the oil level in the tank.
30-104
9 RKPB0990
10
12
11 6
RKPA7290
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
BLADE CYLINDER
REMOVAL OF BLADE CYLINDER Swing the upper revolving frame 90ë to the right and lower the blade and the work equipment to the ground in their safe positions. 1 - Remove the protection (1). 2 - Put the blade cylinder (2) in a sling and put the cable under slight tension.
6
2 8
9
1 7
3 - Switch off the engine and release pressures in the cylinder by moving the lever of the blade PPC valves several times in both directions. 4 - Take out the screw (3) and remove the pin (4).
10
5 3
4 RKPA7300
5 - Start the engine and retract the piston (5). H To hold the piston in its completely retracted position, tie it with wire. 6 - Stop the motor and release any residual hydraulic pressures. (For details, see 20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS). 7 - Disconnect the tubes (6-7) from the safety valve (8). Plug the tubes and the safety valves to prevent entry of impurities. 8 - Take away the screw (9) and remove the pin (10). 9 - Remove the blade cylinder (2).
INSTALLATION OF BLADE CYLINDER .
To install, reverse the removal procedure. H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance on both sides of the piston. When aligning the hole and pin, let the engine run at minimum idling. Do not insert fingers into the hole to check the alignment. Inside bushings: ASL800050 H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance on both sides of the piston.
.
Start the engine and bleed air from the cylinder. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). H After bleeding the air, check the level of oil in the tank.
PC75R-2
30-105
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
WORK EQUIPMENT CYLINDERS
DISASSEMBLY OF WORK EQUIPMENT CYLINDERS 1. All cylinders 1 - Place the cylinder on the tool F8 and partially extract the piston.
3
F8
5
2 - Loosen the retaining screws of the flange (1) that secures the head (2) and take it away. Move the flange (1) towards the piston rod. 3 - Push the head (2) into the cylinder (3) and remove the snap ring (4). H Take great care not to damage the inside of the cylinder. RKPA7310
4 - Slide the piston rod (5) out of the cylinder (3), complete with the flange (1), the snap ring (4), the head (2) and the piston (6).
1
2. 2nd boom, boom swing and blade cylinders:
4
2
5 - Remove the screws (7) and remove the two halfflanges (8).
8 5 4
6
7 RKPA7320
3. Boom, arm and bucket cylinders 1 - Heat the safety valve (9) and the end nut (10) to a temperature of 140 ± 150 ëC (284 ± 302 ëF).
10
2 - Only for arm cylinder: loosen and remove the safety screw (9).
9
3 - Loosen and remove the nut (10). Use the key F7 and the dynamometric key B1. H Before continuing with the dismantling operations, allow the piston rod to cool down.
RKPA7330
3. All cylinders 1 - Take the group to pieces. For the arm cylinder, first take away the thirteen brake pin (12) retaining balls (11) (në 12).
12
7 - Remove the seals from the piston rod, the piston, the head and the flange.
11 RKPA7340
30-106
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
WORK EQUIPMENT CYLINDERS
ASSEMBLY OF THE WORK EQUIPMENT CYLINDERS H Take care not to damage the seals or the sliding surfaces. H Prepare each individual component before final assembly.
3
2
1 1. Assembly of the head-retaining flange.
2
1
1 - Mount the scraper (1) in the external seating of the flange (2), making sure that it is positioned correctly. Drive home the scraper using the press. 2 - Mount the O-ring seal (3). H Use grease to hold the washer in place. Sealant: ASL800050
RKP07300
RKPA7350
6
5
7
1
4
2
3
4
2. Head assembly 1 - Mount the internal central retaining ring, positioning first the O-ring (1) and then the sealing ring (2). H Make sure that the lowering of the retaining ring is turned towards the inside of the cylinder. 2 - Use the tool F1, mount the lip seal (3). H Check that the lips are facing towards the inside of the cylinder.
RKP08000
3 - Mount the guide rings (4). 4 - Mount the O-rings (5) and relative anti-extrusion rings (6) on the outside of the head (7). H Check the position of the anti-extrusion rings (6).
6
5
1
6
2
4
5
6
7
4 3
1
2
RKP08010
F1 3 2
7
RKPA7360
PC75R-2
RKPA7370
30-107
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
WORK EQUIPMENT CYLINDERS
5 - Gauge the diameter of the internal seals, mounting the group underneath the press and using the specific gauging knuckle pin F2 for the diameter of the piston rod.
F2
RKPA7380
3. Piston assembly 1 - Using the tool F3, mount the piston seal. Mount in the correct sequence the rubber ring (1), the external seal (2), and the rings wear (3). 2 - Mount the guide rings (4). 3 - For the arm piston only: Mount the O-ring (5) and the rings wear (6) for the sealing between piston rod and piston.
F3
1 2
RKPA7390
4
2
3
3
4
1
5
6
6 RKP08020
4 - Gauge the diameter of the seal (2) of the piston (7), mounting the group under the press and using the specific gauging ring F4 for the piston diameter.
7
F4
RKPA7400
30-108
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
WORK EQUIPMENT CYLINDERS
4. Piston rod group assembly 1 - Mount on the end of the piston rod (1) the bushing F5 of the correct diameter.
2
1
4
2 - Slide the head-retaining flange (2), the snap ring (3) and the head (4) onto the piston rod. H Check carefully the positioning of the head-retaining flange. 3 - Remove the bushing F5 from the end of the piston.
F5
3 RKPA7410
4 - Mount the O-ring (5) and the rings wear (6) in the endseating, for the sealing between the piston ring and piston. H For boom, arm and bucket piston ring, the seal is housed in the piston itself. 5 - Mount in the correct sequence the brake bushing (7) (for the boom and arm cylinders only) and the piston (8).
5 7
6
8
RKPA7420
6 - For the arm piston only: mount the brake pin (9) and slide the thirteen retaining balls (11) (në 12) into the hole (10).
8
10
7 - Mount the half-flanges (12) that hold the piston (8) in place, and secure them with the screws (13). Flange retaining screws: 49w5 Nm (36.1w3.7 lb.ft.)
11
12
13
9
RKPA7430
For the arm piston only: 1 - Mount the nut (14) that holds the piston (8) in place, and tighten with the socket wrench F7 and the dynamometric tool with multiplier B1. Piston retaining nut: Loctite 262 Piston retaining nut: Boom: 530w53 kgm (3833.5w383.35 lb.ft.) Arm: 300w20 kgm (2170w144.7 lb.ft.) Bucket: 290w29 kgm (2097.5w209.7 lb.ft.) 2 - Mount the safety screw (15). Safety screws: Loctite 262 Safety screws: 9w0.9 kgm (65.1w6.5 lb.ft.)
PC75R-2
8
14 15
RKPA7331
30-109
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
WORK EQUIPMENT CYLINDERS
5. Cylinder assembly 1 - Place the cylinder (1) and the piston rod group (2) on the equipment F8 and align their axes.
1
3
4
2
2 - Lubricate the external seals and insert the piston (3) in the cylinder (1). Piston sealants: Grease ASL800050 H Before inserting the piston, check that the seals are not damaged and that they fit perfectly in their seatings. 3 - Lubricate the external seals of the head (4) and insert it completely into the cylinder (1). Head sealants: Grease ASL800050 H Before inserting the head, check that the seals are not damaged and that they fit perfectly in their seatings.
5
F8
RKPA7311
4 - Using the tool F6, position the snap ring (5) that holds the head (4) in the cylinder seating. H Check that the snap ring is completely inserted in the seating. 5 - Position the flange (6) that holds the head in place, and secure it with the screws (7). H Before positioning the flange, check that the Oring flange seal (8) is in its seating. Flange blocking screws: 5w0.5 kgm (36.2w3.7 lb.ft.)
8
6
F6 RKPA7460
6
7 RKPA7470
30-110
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
WORK EQUIPMENT (For 1-piece boom)
REMOVAL OF WORK EQUIPMENT (For 1-piece boom) Extend the arm fully and open the bucket completely. Lower the work equipment until it is resting on the ground
2
1 - Put a sling around the cylinder (1) of the boom.
7
2 - Switch off the engine, release pressure in the cylinder by moving the PPC valve lever several times. 3 - Remove the screw (2) and draw out the pin (3).
3 6
4
4 - Start the engine to retract the piston (4). H To hold the piston in its fully retracted position, tie it with wire.
1 RKPA7161
5 - Lower the cylinder (1) until it comes to rest on blocks (A). 6 - Switch off the engine and release any residual hydraulic pressures. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). 7 - Remove the overload sensor (For details, see «REMOVAL OF OVERLOAD SENSOR»).
1
8 - Disconnect the hoses (5) and plug them. Also plug the rigid tubes. 9 - Put the equipment in a sling and apply slight tension to the cables. 10 - Remove the screw (6) and the pin (7). Lift off the work equipment (8).
A
Work equipment: 950 kg (2093 lb.)
RKPA7170
INSTALLATION OF WORK EQUIPMENT (For 1-piece boom) .
To install, reverse the removal procedure. H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance (distributed on both sides of the piston) until a clearance of 1 ± 2 mm (0.0394 ± 0.0788 in.) is obtained.
5
5
When aligning the positions between holes and pin, let the engine run at minimum idling. Do not insert fingers into the hole to check the alignment.
RKPA7480
Inside bushings: ASL800050. H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance (distributed on both sides of the arm) until a clearance of 0.5 ± 1 mm (0.0197 ± 0.0394 in.) is obtained. .
Start the engine to circulate the oil, and bleed air from the cylinder. H After bleeding the air, switch off the engine and check oil level in the tank.
8 RKPA7490
PC75R-2
30-111
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
WORK EQUIPMENT (For 2-piece boom)
REMOVAL OF WORK EQUIPMENT (For 2-piece boom) Fully extend the arm and the 2-piece boom and completely curl up the bucket. Position a stand (A) (height 1.60 m (63.04 in.)) between the boom and the 2-piece boom, and rest the back of the bucket on the ground. Stabilise the machine by resting the blade and/or the stabilisers on the ground.
A
Completely eliminate residual pressures from all the circuits. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»).
RKPA7500
1 - Disconnect the boom cylinder (1) from the 2-piece boom and rest it on a stand (B). H In order to disconnect the boom cylinder, it is necessary to remove the RH cylinder of the 2-piece boom. (See «REMOVAL OF 2-PIECE BOOM CYLINDERS up to point 11).
2 1
A
After having disconnected the boom cylinder, reassemble the RH cylinder of the 2-piece boom with the pin (2) and fasten it with its own screws.
B RKPA7530
2 - Disconnect the eight hoses (3) (në 8) that control the front work equipment cylinders, and plug them. Also plug the union fittings of the hoses (4).
3
4
RKPA7520
3 - Put the boom (5) in a sling and apply slight tension to the cables. H Pass the cables through the rigid tubes to avoid distortion.
5 7
4 - Remove the screws (6) and take out the pin (7).
6
5 - Raise the boom (5) until it is disengaged from the swivel support (8) and take away the stand (A). Equipment: 1300 kg (2864 lb.)
A
8 RKPA7510
30-112
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
6 - Swing the group to the side of the machine and rest the boom on a stand (C).
WORK EQUIPMENT (For 2-piece boom)
5 C
RKP08030
INSTALLATION OF THE WORK EQUIPMENT (For 2-piece boom) .
To install, reverse the removal procedure. H Insert the shims (distributed on both sides of the top of the cylinder) until a clearance of 1 ± 2 mm (0.0394 ± 0.0788 in.) is obtained. When aligning the positions between holes and pin, let the engine run at minimum idling. Do not insert fingers into the hole to check the alignment. Inside bushings: ASL800050 H Insert the shims (distributed on both sides of the top of the piston rod) until a clearance of 1 ± 2 mm (0.0394 ± 0.0788 in.) is obtained.
.
Start the engine to circulate the oil, and bleed air from the cylinder. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). H After bleeding the air, switch off engine and check oil level in the tank.
PC75R-2
30-113
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
BUCKET
REMOVAL OF BUCKET Lower the bucket to the ground, resting with its back on a flat surface. 1 - Take out the safety pin (1) and the connecting pin (2) between bucket (3) and tie-rod (4).
4
6 2
2 - Take out the safety pin (5) and the pin (6) that connects the bucket to the arm (7).
INSTALLATION OF BUCKET .
7
1
5 3
RKPA7540
To install, reverse the removal procedure. H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance between bucket (3) and tie-rod (4). When lining up the hole and the pin, let the engine turn at low idling speed. Do not insert fingers into the holes to check alignment. Inside bushings: ASL800050 H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance (on both sides) between the bucket (3) and the arm (7), until a play of 0.5 ± 1 mm (0.0197 ± 0.0394 in.) is obtained.
30-114
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ARM
REMOVAL OF ARM 1 - Remove the bucket (For details, see «REMOVAL OF BUCKET»).
1
2 - Remove the bucket cylinder. (For details, see «REMOVAL OF BUCKET CYLINDER»). 3 - If the machine is designed for the application of optional front equipment, disconnect the boom (or the 2piece boom), the tubes (1) and remove the supports (2).
2 RKPA7550
4 - Loosen the ring nut (3) and pin (4) and remove the thrust lever (5).
3 5
4 RKPA7560
5 - Raise the boom and bring the arm (6) into a vertical position and then lower it to the ground.
6
RKP08100
6 - Switch off the engine and release residual pressures. 7 - Put the arm cylinder (7) in a sling, remove the screw (8) and take out the pin (9).
9
7
10
8 - Start the engine and fully retract the piston (10). H To hold the piston rod in its fully retracted position, tie it with wire.
8
RKPA7570
PC75R-2
30-115
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ARM
9 - Rest the cylinder (7) on a block (A). 10 - Switch off the engine.
7
A RKPA7580
11 - Connect the arm (7) to the hoisting tackle and apply slight tension to the cable. 12 - Remove the cotter-pin (11) and the nut (12).
12 11
RKPA7590
13 - Take out the screw (13) and pull out the pin (14). 14 - Lift off the arm (6).
6
Arm: 125 kg (275.4 lb.) Long arm: 167 kg (368 lb.)
14 13 RKPA7600
15 - Start the engine and, for reasons of safety, lower the boom or 2-piece boom until it rests on the ground.
RKPB1260
30-116
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ARM
INSTALLATION OF ARM .
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Inside bushings: ASL800050 H Insert shim When aligning the positions between holes and pin, do not insert fingers into the hole to check the alignment. H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance (distributed on both sides of the piston) until a clearance of 1 ± 2 mm (0.0394 ± 0.0788 in.) is obtained. When aligning the positions between holes and pin, let the engine run at minimum idling. Do not insert fingers into the holes to check the alignment. Inside bushings: ASL800050 H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance (distributed on both sides) until a clearance of 0.5 ± 1 mm (0.0197 ± 0.0394 in.) is obtained. When aligning the positions between hole and pin, do not insert fingers into the holes to check the alignment.
PC75R-2
30-117
2nd BOOM
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
REMOVAL OF 2nd BOOM 1 - Remove the bucket, the bucket cylinder, the arm cylinder and the arm. For details see: .
REMOVAL OF BUCKET
.
REMOVAL OF BUCKET CYLINDER
.
REMOVAL OF ARM CYLINDER
.
REMOVAL OF ARM
1
2 - Start the engine and bring the 2-piece boom (1) into a vertical position. Lower it until it rests on the ground and switch off the engine.
RKPB1261
3 - Put a sling round the RH cylinder (2) of the 2-piece boom and remove the nut (3), the screw (4) and the shim (5).
2
4 - Slide out the pin (6) that connects the RH cylinder (2) to the 2-piece boom (1) until the piston rod is completely disconnected.
2
5
5
3 6 4
6
RKPA7211
5 - Start the engine and completely retract the piston rod of the RH cylinder. H To hold the piston rod in a fully retracted position, tie it with wire and switch off the engine. 6 - Lower the cylinder until it is in a vertical position, leaving the boom tied up. 7 - Repeat these operations from point 3 to point 6 in order to disconnect the LH cylinder (7).
RKPA7221
8 - Hook the 2-piece boom to the hoisting tackle. 9 - Remove the screws and take out the pin (8).
8
10 - Take off the 2-piece boom. 2-piece boom: 162 kg (357 lb.)
1 7 RKPA7610
30-118
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
2nd BOOM
INSTALLATION OF 2nd BOOM .
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Self-locking nut: 118 Nm (87 lb.ft.). Inside bushings: ASL800050. When aligning the positions between holes and pin, let the engine run at minimum idling. Do not insert fingers into the hole to check the alignment.
.
.
Insert the shims (distributed on both sides of the boom) until a clearance of 0.5 ± 1 mm (0.0197 ± 0.0394 in.) is obtained. Start the engine to circulate the oil, and bleed air from the cylinder. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). H After bleeding the air, switch off the engine and check the oil level in the tank.
PC75R-2
30-119
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
BOOM (For 1-piece boom)
REMOVAL OF BOOM (For 1-piece boom) 1 - Remove the arm (For details, see «REMOVAL OF ARM»). 2 - Remove the arm cylinder. (For details, see «REMOVAL OF ARM CYLINDER»). 3 - Start the engine and lower the boom to the ground. 4 - Switch off the engine and move the PPC valve several times to release pressures in the cylinder. 5 - Put the boom cylinder in a sling (1). 6 - Take out the screw (2) and pull out the pin (3).
2
3 4 1
7 - Start the engine and fully retract the piston (4). H To hold the piston rod in its fully retracted position, tie it with wire. 8 - Switch off the engine and release all pressures. (For details, see «20. TESTING AND ADJUSTMENTS»). 9 - Lower the piston until it is resting on blocks (A). 10 - Remove the overload sensor. (For details, see «REMOVAL OF OVERLOAD SENSOR»). 11 - Put the boom (5) in a sling, using the attachment hole in the arm cylinder. Apply slight tension to the cable. 12 - Disconnect the front equipment hoses (6) and plug them. Also plug the rigid tubes (7). 13 - Take out the screw (8) and pull out the pin (9). 14 - Lift off the boom (5).
RKPA7162
9
1
8
A RKPA7171
Boom: 300 kg (661 lb.)
INSTALLATION OF BOOM (For 1-piece boom) .
5
To install, reverse the removal procedure. H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance (distributed on both sides of the piston rod) until a clearance of 1 ± 2 mm (0.0394 ± 0.0788 in.) is obtained. When aligning the positions between holes and pin, let the engine run at minimum idling. Do not insert fingers into the hole to check the alignment.
RKPA7620
7
7
Inside bushings: ASL800050
.
H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance (distributed on both sides of the boom) until a clearance of 0.5 ± 1 mm (0.0197 ± 0.0394 in.) is obtained. Start the engine to circulate the oil and bleed air from the cylinders. H After bleeding the air, switch off the engine and check the oil level in the tank.
30-120
6
6
RKPA7481
PC75R-2
1st BOOM
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
REMOVAL OF 1st BOOM 1 - Remove the bucket, the bucket cylinder, the arm cylinder, the arm, and the 2-piece boom. For details see: .
REMOVAL OF BUCKET
.
REMOVAL OF BUCKET CYLINDER
.
REMOVAL OF ARM CYLINDER
.
REMOVAL OF ARM
.
REMOVAL OF 2-PIECE BOOM
2 - Replace the fulcrum pin (1) of the 2-piece boom and secure it with the proper screws.
2
1
3 - Manoeuvre the boom (2) until the fulcrum pin is resting on a stand (A), 1.60 m (63.04 in.) high.
A
4 - Switch off the engine and release any residual pressures in the boom cylinder. 5 - Remove the 2-piece boom cylinders (3) and let the boom cylinder (4) rest on a stand. (For details, see «REMOVAL OF 2-PIECE BOOM CYLINDER»).
3 4 RKPA7630
6 - Remove the overload sensor. (For details, see «REMOVAL OF OVERLOAD SENSOR»). 7 - Disconnect the six connecting hoses of the front work equipment cylinders (5) (në 6) and the two tubes (6) of the optional equipment (në 2). H Plug the hoses and rigid tubes to prevent entry of impurities.
7
6
5
RKPA7521
8 - Take out the four screws (7) (në 4) and lift away the complete rack of tubes.
7
RKPA7440
PC75R-2
30-121
1st BOOM
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
9 - Screw four M10 UNI 2947 eyebolts (8) as far as they will go into the holes of the rack of tubes.
8
10 - Attach the hoisting tackle to the eyebolts and apply slight tension to the cables.
10
11 - Take out the screws (9) and remove the pin (10). 12 - Lift away the entire boom (2). Boom: 245 kg (540 lb.)
2
9 RKPB1270
INSTALLATION OF 1ST BOOM .
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Inside bushings: ASL800050 Do not insert fingers in the holes in order to check the alignment.
.
H Insert shims on both sides of the boom, until a clearance of 0.5 ± 1 mm (0.0197 ± 0.0394 in.) is obtained. Start the engine to let the oil circulate and bleed air from the cylinders. H After bleeding the air, switch off the engine and check the level in the oil tank.
30-122
PC75R-2
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
SWING BRACKET
REMOVAL OF SWING BRACKET Extend the work equipment fully and rest it on the ground. 1 - Remove the front work equipment. (For details see «REMOVAL OF WORK EQUIPMENT»).
1
H1
2 - Remove the boom cylinder (For details, see «REMOVAL OF BOOM CYLINDER»). 3 - Take out the screws and remove the pins (4). 4 - Attach the swing bracket (1) to the hoisting tackle H1 and apply slight tension to the cable. RKPA7450
5 - Place a jack (3) beneath the lower pin (2). 6 - Take out the retaining screws and pull out the pin (2). 7 - Take out the retaining screws and, with the help of a lever, pull out the upper pin (4). 8 - Lift out the swing bracket (1). Swing bracket: 170 kg (374.5 lb.)
2
INSTALLATION OF SWING SUPPORT .
3
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
RKPA7650
Lower pin: ASL800050 Upper pin: ASL800050 H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance between the chassis and the support.
4
Unit: mm
Thickness
Pos.
Code No.
1
21D-09-39170
5
2
2
21D-09-39160
0.5
2
Quantity
RKPA7660
Supporting surfaces and adjustments to a given clearance: ASL800050
2 H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance (distributed on both sides of the eyes piston) until a clearance of 1 ± 2 mm (0.0394 ± 0.0788 in.) is obtained. When aligning the positions between hole and pin, run the engine at idling. Do not introduce hand fingers in the holes to check the alignment.
PC75R-2
2 1 RKP07490
30-123
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
BLADE
REMOVAL OF BLADE 1 - Remove the blade cylinder (For details, see «REMOVAL OF BLADE CYLINDER»).
1 2
2 - Attach the hoisting tackle to the blade, using the holes provided on the sides (1) and the piston coupling (2). H Adjust the length of the chains to keep the group in equilibrium.
1
3 - Loosen the screws (3) and remove the pin (4). 4 - Remove the blade (5).
5 RKPA7670
Blade: 250 kg (551 lb.)
INSTALLATION OF BLADE .
3
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Inside bushings: ASL800050
4
When aligning the positions between hole and pin, run the engine at minimum idling. Do not insert fingers in the holes to check the alignment. RKPA7680
H Insert the adjustments to a given clearance (distributed on both sides of the fulcrum bushings).
30-124
PC75R-2
GROUP
40
40-28
PC15R-8
MAINTENANCE STANDARD
P.T.O. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 2 Swing circle. . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 3 Track frame. . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 4 Idler . . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 5 Carrier roller . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 6 Track roller. . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 7 Track shoe . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 8 Sprocket .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . 9 Swing machinery . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 10 Hydraulic pump . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 11 Control valve . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . 12
PC75R-2
Swing motor . . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 22 Swivel joint. .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 23 Travel motor . . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 24 Servocontrol feed unit . . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 26 Travel PPC valve .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 27 PPC valve . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 28 Blade safety valve. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 30 Cylinders . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 32 Work equipment (1-piece boom) . . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 34 Work equipment (2-piece boom) . . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . .. . . . 36
40-1
P.T.O.
44 Nm (32.4 lb.ft.) 50 Nm (36.8 lb.ft.)
50 Nm (36.8 lb.ft.) RKP08291
40-2
PC75R-2
SWING CIRCLE
314 Nm (230.5 lb.ft.) with Loctite 262
Section B - B Sezione B - B
1
Section AA- -AA Sezione
C D
C
Section C -- CC Sezione C 314 Nm (230.5 lb.ft.)
B
D A A D D C
Section D Sezione D D -- D
B RKP08171
C
Unit: mm (in.)
No.
Check item
Axial clearance
PC75R-2
Criteria
Remedy
Standard clearance
Clearance limit
0.04 ± 0.20 (0.0016 ± 0.0078)
0.50 (0.02)
Replace
40-3
TRACK FRAME 1
2
4
3
RKP08121
Unit: mm (in.)
No.
1
2
3
Check item
Deformation of frame
Vertical width of idler guide
Horizontal width of idler guide
Criteria
Remedy
Item
Repair limit
Curvature
5 (for 1000 mm) (0.197 for 39.4 in.)
Torsion
5 (for 300 mm) (0.197 for 11.8 in.)
Opening of idler portion
5 (0.197)
Item
Standard side
Limit side
Track frame
61 (2.403)
66 (2.600)
Idler support
60 (2.184)
57 (2.127)
Track frame
161 (6.343)
166 (6.540)
Idler support
160 (6.304)
155 (6.107)
Rebuild
Build up welding or replace
Standard side 4
40-4
Recoil spring
Free length
Installed length
Installed load
233 (9.180)
203 (7.998)
4000 kg (8.812 lb.)
Replace
PC75R-2
IDLER
4 3
5 55w5 Nm (40.5w3.7 lb.ft.)
2
1
6
7
RKP08820
Unit: mm (in.)
No.
Check item
1
Outer diameter of protrusion
2
Criteria
Remedy
Standard size
Repair limit
408 (16.1)
398 (15.7)
Outer diameter of tread
380 (13.79)
370 (14.578)
3
Width of protrusion
54 (2.127)
45 (1.773)
4
Total width
105 (4.137)
96 (3.782)
5
Width of tread
25.5 (1.005)
30 (1.182)
Standard size 6
7
Clearance between shaft and bushing
End play of idler
PC75R-2
42 (1.654)
Tolerance Shaft +0 ± 0.025 ( ± 0.001)
Hole + 0.133 (+ 0.0052) ± 0.025 (±0.001)
Build up welding or replace
Standard Clearance clearance limit 0.133 (0.0052) 0.262 (0.01)
Standard size
Repair limit
0.65 ± 1.2 (0.026 ± 0.047)
2 (0.0788)
1.5 (0.06)
Replace
40-5
CARRIER ROLLER
6
1
585 Nm (23.05 lb.ft.)
2
5
3 4
7 RKP10380
Unit: mm (in.)
No.
Check item
Criteria
Remedy
Standard size
Repair limit
145 (5.713)
136 (5.358)
120 (4.728)
111 (4.373)
1
Outer diameter of tread
2
Outer diameter of protrusion
3
Width of protrusion
53 (2.088)
45 (1.773)
4
Total width
110 (4.334)
102 (4.018)
5
Width of tread
28.5 (1.122)
32.5 (1.280)
Standard size 6
7
Interference between shaft and ring
End play of idler
40-6
36 (1.418)
Tolerance Shaft + 0.085 (+0.0033) ± 0.060 (± 0.0023)
Hole + 0.039 (+0.0015) ±0
Build up welding or replace
Standard Clearance clearance limit 0.085 ± 0.015 0.021 (0.0006) (0.0033 ± 0.010 0.0008) (0.0004)
Standard size
Repair limit
0.1 ± 0.6 (0.0039 - 0.0024)
1.2 (0.047)
Replace
PC75R-2
TRACK ROLLER
6 Nm (4.42 lb.ft.)
3
4
2
1
7
6
5
RKP08810
Unit: mm (in.)
No.
Check item
Criteria Standard size
Repair limit
160 (6.30)
150 (5.91)
Tread outside diameter
135 (5.32)
125 (4.92)
Tread width
28 (1.103)
32 (1.26)
Flange width
14 (0.55)
10 (0.394)
1
Outer diameter of tread
2 3 4
Standard size 5
6
7
Remedy
Clearance between shaft and bushing
Interference between roller and bushing
End play of idler
PC75R-2
40 (1.57) Standard size 48 (1.89)
Tolerance
Standard Clearance clearance limit
Shaft
Hole
0.025 (0.0009)
+ 0.189 (0.0074) + 0.075 (0.0030)
Tolerance Shaft
Hole
+ 0.07 (0.0028) + 0.095 (0.0037)
0.039 (0.0015)
0.075 ± 0.214 (0.0030 ± 0.0084)
1.5 (0.059)
Standard clearance
Interfer. limit
0.095 ± 0.031 (0.0037 ± 0.0012)
0.015 (0.0006)
Standard tolerance
Clearance limit
0.2 ± 1.2 (0.0079 ± 0.047)
2 (0.0788)
40-7
TRACK SHOE
3
4 1
160w10 Nm (118w7.4 lb.ft.)
6
8
7
2
5
RKP08800
Unit: mm (in.)
No.
Check item
Criteria
Remedy
Standard size
Repair limit
140 (5.52)
143.6 (5.66)
Bushing outside diameter
37 (1.46)
34 (1.34)
Turn or replace
3
Grouser height
18 (0.71)
6 (0.24)
Lud welding rebuild or replace
4
Link height
70 (2.76)
66 (2.60)
Rebuild or replace
1
Link pitch
2
Standard size 5
Interference between bushing and link
Shaft +0
37 (1.46)
6
Interference between regular pin and link
25 (0.98)
7
Interference between master pin and link
25 (0.98)
8
Clearance between link joint surface
40-8
Tolerance
37.5 ± 0.1
+0
(1.48 ± 0.004)
25 0.1 (0.98 0.004
Hole 36.72
+0.1 ± 0.1
(1.45
+0.004 ± 0.004
)
24.70 ±+0.1 0.1 (0.97
+0.004 ± 0.004
)
24.88w0.03 24.70 +0.1 ± 0.1 (0.098w0.0012) (0.97 +0.004 ) ± 0.004
Turn or replace
Standard interf.
Interfer. limit
0.33 ± 0.13 (0.119 ± 0.0051)
Ð
0.4 ± 0.2 (0.0157 ± 0.0079)
Ð
0.21 ± 0.05 (0.0083 ± 0.0197)
Ð
Standard tolerance
Clearance limit
1 (0.0394)
Ð
Replace
Replace
PC75R-2
SPROCKET
2
1
180 Nm with Loctite
3 4 RKP08790
Unit: mm (in.)
No.
Check item
1
Wear of roots of sprocket teeth
2
Criteria Standard size
Tolerance
Remedy Repair limit
438 (17.14)
3(
0.12)
425 (16.74)
Wear of tips of sprocket teeth
495 (19.5)
2(
0.079)
482 (18.99)
3
Face width of sprocket teeth (teeth crest)
32 (1.26)
4
Face width of sprocket teeth (bottom land)
46 (1.81)
PC75R-2
Ð 1.5 (
29 (1.14) 0.059)
42 (1.65)
40-9
SWING MACHINERY
1
58.8 ± 73.5 Nm (43.3 ± 54.2 lb.ft)
2
ASL800070
4 3
6
7 5 RKP08780
Unit: mm (in.)
No.
Check item
1
Backlash between No. 1 sun gear and No. 1 planetary gear
2
Criteria
Remedy
Standard clearance
Clearance limit
0.11 ± 0.31 (0.0043 ± 0.0122)
0.6 (0.0236)
Backlash between No. 1 planetary gear and ring gear
0.12 ± 0.40 (0.0047 ± 0.0157)
0.6 (0.0236)
3
Backlash between No. 2 and gear and No. 2 planetary gear
0.11 ± 0.31 (0.0043 ± 0.0122)
0.6 (0.0236)
4
Backlash between No. 1 planetary gear and ring gear
0.12 ± 0.40 (0.0047 ± 0.0157)
0.6 (0.0236)
5
Backlash between swing pinion and swing circle gear
0.22 ± 0.85 (0.0087 ± 0.0335)
2.0 (0.0787)
6
Wear of swing pinion shaft surface contacting with oil seal
7
Wear of swing pinion collar surface contacting with dust seal
40-10
Standard side
Tolerance
65 (2.56)
0.074 (0.0029)
125 (4.92)
± 0.043 (0.0017) ± 0.106 (0.0042)
Repair limit 64.8 (2.55) 124.8 (4.914)
Replace
Repair hard chrome plating or replace
PC75R-2
HYDRAULIC PUMP
Z
Y 68.6w9.8 Nm (50.6w0.737 lb.ft.)
7.35w1.47 Nm (5.4w1.1 lb.ft.)
17.2w2.5 Nm (12.7w1.8 lb.ft.)
View ZZ Vista
110.3w12.3 Nm (81.4w9.1 lb.ft)
View Y Vista Y
12.3w7.4 Nm (9.1w5.5 lb.ft.)
PC75R-2
RKP08211
40-11
CONTROL VALVE
A
D
C B AA
AA
M
M L
L
K
K
J
J
H
H
G
G
G
G
F
F
E
E
BB
BB D
29.4 ± 39.2 Nm (21.7 ± 28.9 lb.ft.)
250 ± 253 Nm (184.4 ± 186.6 lb.ft.)
1st tightening: 19.6 ± 29.4 Nm (14.5 ± 21.7 lb.ft.) 2nd tightening: 39.2 ± 49 Nm (28.9 ± 36.2 lb.ft.) 3rd tightening: 58.8 ± 73.5 Nm (43.4 ± 54.2 lb.ft.)
1
3
4
2
C
B
A
Tightening following 1-2-3-4 order in 3 times
RKP03100
40-12
PC75R-2
39 ± 49 Nm (28.8 ± 36.2 lb.ft.)
39 ± 49 Nm (28.8 ± 36.2 lb.ft.)
39 ± 49 Nm (28.8 ± 36.2 lb.ft.)
39 ± 49 Nm (28.8 ± 36.2 lb.ft.)
39 ± 49 Nm (28.8 ± 36.2 lb.ft.) 1
39 ± 49 Nm (28.8 ± 36.2 lb.ft.)
107.8 ± 147 Nm (79.5 ± 108.4 lb.ft.) Section A - A Sezione A - A RKP03110
Unit: mm (in.)
No.
Check item
Criteria
Remedy
Standard size 1
Cooler by-pass valve spring
PC75R-2
Repair limit
Free length x O.D.
Installed length
Installed load
Free length x O.D.
Installed load
Ð
33 (1.3)
231.4 N (23.6 kg)
Ð
Ð
Replace
40-13
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
3
1
1
1
1
1
1
3
3
Section Sezione B B -- BB
RKP02781
Unit: mm (in.)
No.
1
Check item Spool return spring (Work equipment, swing, boom, arm, bucket, boom swing, blade, travel, equipment)
Criteria
Remedy
Standard size
Repair limit
Free length x O.D.
Installed length
Installed load
Free length x O.D.
Installed load
Ð
40.5 (1.6)
34.7 N (3.5 kg)
Ð
Ð
2
Spool return spring (Arm)
Ð
40.5 (1.6)
54.6 N (5.6 kg)
Ð
Ð
3
Spool return spring (Boom, swing)
Ð
40.5 (1.6)
4.9 N (5 kg)
Ð
Ð
40-14
Replace
PC75R-2
1 118 ± 162 Nm (87 ± 119.5 lb.ft.)
118 ± 162 Nm (87 ± 119.5 lb.ft.)
1 1
1 118 ± 162 Nm (87 ± 119.5 lb.ft.)
4 2 1
1 3
Section C - C Sezione C - C RKP02791
Unit: mm (in.)
No.
Check item
Criteria
Remedy
Standard size 1
Pressure compensation valve spring
Repair limit
Free length x O.D.
Installed length
Installed load
Free length x O.D.
Installed load
Ð
14.5 (0.57)
13.72 N (1.4 kg)
Ð
Ð
2
Pressure compensation valve spring (boom)
Ð
21.5 (0.85)
55.9w3 N (5.7w0.34 kg)
Ð
Ð
3
Spool (boom raise at joining pump discharge)
Ð
36 (1.42)
238.3 N (24.3 kg)
Ð
Ð
4
Flow compensation valve spring (boom)
Ð
20 (0.79)
27.6 N (2.82 kg)
Ð
Ð
PC75R-2
Replace
40-15
24.5 ± 34.3 Nm (18.1 ± 25.3 lb.ft.)
1
1
1
1
1
1 2
58.8 ± 78.5 Nm (43.4 ± 57.9 lb.ft.)
Section SezioneDD- -DD
RKP02801
Unit: mm (in.)
No.
Check item
Criteria
Remedy
Standard size 1
2
Check valve spring
Check valve spring (Swing)
40-16
Repair limit
Free length x O.D.
Installed length
Installed load
Free length x O.D.
Installed load
Ð
22 (0.876)
3.92 N (0.4 kg)
Ð
Ð
Ð
11.5 (0.453)
13.7 N (1.4 kg)
Ð
Ð
Replace
PC75R-2
107.8 ± 147 Nm (79.5 ± 108.4 lb.ft.)
1
49 ± 59 Nm (28.8 ± 36.2 lb.ft.)
Section BB - BB Sezione BB - BB
19.6 ± 27.4 Nm (14.4 ± 20.2 lb.ft.) with Loctite 638
RKP02821
65.7 ± 85.3 Nm (48.5 ± 62.9 lb.ft.)
Section E - E Sezione E - E
RKP02811
Unit: mm (in.)
No.
1
Check item
Lift check valve spring
PC75R-2
Criteria
Remedy
Free length x O.D.
Installed length
Installed load
Free length x O.D.
Installed load
Ð
44.9 (1.768)
36,3 N (3.7 kg)
Ð
Ð
Replace
40-17
34 ± 44 Nm (25.1 ± 32.5 lb.ft.)
88.3 ± 107.9 Nm (65.1 ± 79.6 lb.ft.)
34 ± 44 Nm (3.5 ± 4.5 kgm)
19.6 ± 27.5 Nm (14.4 ± 20.2 lb.ft) 34 ± 44 Nm (3.5 ± 4.5 kgm) Section AA - AA
RKP02841
Sezione AA - AA
39 ± 49 Nm (28.8 ± 36.2 lb.ft.)
49 ± 59 Nm (36.2 ± 43.5 lb.ft.) Section F - F
Sezione F - F
40-18
RKP02831
PC75R-2
RKP02851
Section G - G Sezione G - G
14.7 ± 19.6 Nm (10.8 ± 14.5 lb.ft.) with Loctite 638
14.7 ± 19.6 Nm (10.8 ± 14.5 lb.ft.) with Loctite 638 Section H - H Sezione H - H
PC75R-2
RKP02861
40-19
14.7 ± 19.6 Nm (10.8 ± 14.5 lb.ft) with Loctite 638
14.7 ± 19.6 Nm (10.8 ± 14.5 lb.ft) with Loctite 638 SectionJ J- J- J Sezione
RKP02871
14.7 ± 19.6 Nm (10.8 ± 14.5 lb.ft) with Loctite 638
Section K - K
Sezione K - K
40-20
RKP02881
PC75R-2
14.7 ± 19.6 Nm (10.8 ± 14.5 lb.ft) with Loctite 638
Section L - L Sezione L - L
RKP02891
14.7 ± 19.6 Nm (10.8 ± 14.5 lb.ft) with Loctite 638
30 ± 25 Nm (22.1 ± 18.5 lb.ft.)
Section M - M Sezione M - M
RKP02901
147 ± 186 Nm (108.4 ± 137.2 lb.ft.)
RKP02911
Section SezioneNN- -NN
PC75R-2
40-21
SWING MOTOR
250 ± 253 Nm (184.4 ± 186.6 lb.ft.)
1
RKP10390
Unit: mm (in.)
No.
1
Check item
Suction valve spring
40-22
Criteria
Remedy
Free length x O.D.
Installed length
Installed load
Free length x O.D.
Installed load
Ð
21.9 (0.862)
3.42 N (0.35 kg)
Ð
Ð
Replace
PC75R-2
SWIVEL JOINT
1
RKP03950
Unit: mm (in.)
No.
Check item
Criteria Standard size
1
Clearance between shaft and rotor
Tolerance
Shaft 85 (3.346) Hole
PC75R-2
± 0.02 (±0.0008) ± 0.05 (±0.002) + 0.10 (+0.004) + 0.15 (+0.006)
Remedy Standard Clearance clearance limit
0.12 ± 0.20 (0.005 ± 0.008)
0.25 (0.009)
Replace
40-23
TRAVEL MOTOR
1
2
1
10
2
5
6
13 -14
13 -14
13 -14
4
9
8
12
11
3
7 RKP08690
40-24
PC75R-2
No.
1
Check item
Check valve spring
Criteria
Remedy
Free length
Installed length
Installed load
Free length
Installed load
Ð
Ð
Ð
Ð
Ð
2
Spool return spring
Ð
Ð
Ð
Ð
Ð
3
Piston spring
Ð
Ð
Ð
Ð
Ð
4
Brake spring
Ð
Ð
Ð
Ð
Ð
5
Friction plate
Standard size
Limit size
2.8 (0.110)
2.5 (0.098)
Ð
0.2 (0.008)
20.5 (0.807)
20.521 (0.808)
6
Sealing surface distance piece
7
Diameter of reaned holes
8
Piston diameter
16.995 (0.669)
16.985 (0.668)
9
Cylinder bore diameter
17.004 (0.669)
17.014 (0.670)
10
Radial clearance of spool
0.012 ± 0.018 (0.0005 ± 0.0007)
0.023 (0.0009)
11
Play of piston ball in shoe
0.1 (0.004)
0.2 (0.008)
12
Play of piston ball in shoe
Standard clearance
Clearance limit
0.05 (0.002)
0.15 (0.006)
Normal value
Limit value
13
Flacking of trochoid tooth surface RV-A gear, RV-B gear, input gear, spur gear, crankshaft, pins.
Ð
Max. 6.5 mm2
14
Pitting of trochoid tooth surface of RV-A gear, RV-B gear, input gear, spurg gear, crankshaft.
PC75R-2
Replace
Replace
Replace spindle Replace Replace spool
Replace
Replace Ð
Max. 1 mm2
40-25
SERVOCONTROL FEED UNIT
3
22.0 w4.9 Nm (16.2w3.6 lb.ft)
29.4w4.9 Nm (21.7w3.6 lb.ft)
9.8w2 Nm (7.2w1.5 lb.ft.)
1
66.2 w7.3 Nm (48.8w5.4 lb.ft.) Section A - A Sezione A - A
2
9.8w2 Nm (7.2w1.5 lb.ft.)
4
Section B - B Sezione B - B RKP04090
Unit: mm (in.)
No.
Check item
Criteria
Remedy
Standard size 1
Reducing valve main spring
Repair limit
Free length x O.D.
Installed length
Installed load
Free length x O.D.
Installed load
19.2x7.2 (0.756x0.283)
16.1 (0.634)
19.6 N (2 kg)
Ð
17.7 N (1.8 kg)
2
Reducing valve pilot spring
16.5x7.2 (0.649x0.283)
12.7 (0.500)
20.6 N (2.1 kg)
Ð
18.6 N (1.9 kg)
3
Spring
71x18 (2.795x0.709)
59 (2.323)
199.8 N (20.4 kg)
Ð
186.2 N (19 kg)
4
Spring
16.1x7.8 (0.634x0.307)
13.4 (0.527)
61.7 N (6.3 kg)
Ð
58.8 N (6 kg)
40-26
Replace
PC75R-2
TRAVEL PPC VALVE 4.4w0.5 Nm (3.24w0.4 lb.ft.)
27.9w3.4 Nm (20.6w2.5 lb.ft.)
2 1
8.5w2.5 Nm (6.2w1.8 lb.ft.)
6.5w2.5 Nm (4.8w1.8 lb.ft.)
Section B - B Sezione B - B
Sezione A - A
Section A - A
8.8w1 Nm (6.5w0.7 lb.ft.)
30.9w3.4 Nm (22.8w2.5 lb.ft.)
Section SezioneDD -- D D
Section C Sezione C C -- C
RKP04100
Unit: mm (in.)
No.
Check item
Criteria
Remedy
Standard size 1
2
Centering spring
Metering spring
PC75R-2
Repair limit
Free length x O.D.
Installed length
Installed load
Free length x O.D.
Installed load
26.5x8.15 (1.043x0.321)
24.9 (0.980)
16,7 N (1.7 kg)
Ð
13.7 N (1.4 kg)
48.1x15.5 (1.894x0.610)
32.5 (1.279)
107.8 N (11 kg)
Ð
86,2 N (8.8 kg)
Replace
40-27
PPC VALVE Boom, arm, bucket, swing
112.8w14.7 Nm (83.2w10.8 lb.ft.) 13.2w1.5 Nm (9.7w1.1 lb.ft.)
1 44.1 w4.9 Nm (32.5w3.6 lb.ft.)
3
Section B - B
Section A - A Sezione A - A
Sezione B - B
8.3w 2.5 Nm (6.1w1.8 lb.ft.)
2
Section SezioneDD-- D D 6.4w 2.5 Nm (4.7w1.8 lb.ft.)
3
Section C - C Sezione C - C Section E E --EE Sezione
RKP01331
Unit: mm (in.)
No
Check item
Criteria
Remedy
Standard size 1
Metering spring (For P3 and P4 port))
Repair limit
Free length x O.D.
Installed length
Installed load
Free length x O.D.
Installed load
38.7x15.5 (1.524x0.610)
34 (1.339)
9.8 N (1.0 kg)
Ð
7.8 N (0.8 kg)
2
Centering spring (For P1 and P2 port)
42.5x15.5 (1.673x0.610)
34 (1.339)
17.6 N (1.8 kg)
Ð
13.7 N (1.4 kg)
3
Metering spring
26.1x8.2 (1.028x0.323)
24.7 (0.972)
15.2 N (1.55 kg)
Ð
11.8 N (1.2 kg)
40-28
Replace if damaged or deformed
PC75R-2
PPC VALVE Blade, boom swing, 2-piece boom
1
2
RKP04110
Unit: mm (in.)
No
Check item
Criteria
Remedy
Standard size 1
2
Metering spring
Centering spring
PC75R-2
Repair limit
Free length x O.D.
Installed length
Installed load
Free length x O.D.
Installed load
33.9x15.3 (1.335x0.602)
28.4 (1.118)
124.5 N (12.7 kg)
Ð
100.0 N (10.2 kg)
22.7x8.1 (0.894x0.319)
22.0 (0.866)
16,7 N (1.7 kg)
Ð
13.7 N (1.4 kg)
40-29
BLADE SAFETY VALVE
A
A
75 Nm (55.3 lb.ft.) 10 ± 12 Nm (7.4 ± 8.8 lb.ft.)
1 2
RKP04620
Section A A -- AA Sezione
Unit: mm (in.)
No
Check item
Criteria
Remedy
Standard size
1
2
Spring
Spring
40-30
Repair limit
Free length x O.D.
Installed length
Installed load
Free length x O.D.
Installed load
31.2x6.10 (1.228x0.240)
Ð
Ð
Ð
Ð
14x10.7 (0.551x0.421)
Ð
Ð
Ð
Ð
Replace if damaged or deformed
PC75R-2
PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
PC75R-2
40-31
CYLINDERS Boom: 5194w519 Nm (3831w382.8 lb.ft.) Bucket: 2842w284 Nm (2097w209 lb.ft.) with Loctite 262
Bucket Boom
1 3
2
RKP08711
49 Nm (36.1 lb.ft.) with Loctite 262
88 Nm (64.9 lb.ft.) with Loctite 262
Arm
1 3
2
RKP08721
49 Nm (36.1 lb.ft.)
Boom swing 2-piece boom Blade
2940w196 Nm (2168w144.5 lb.ft.) with Loctite 262
1 3
2 RKP08741
49 Nm (36.1 lb.ft.)
40-32
49 Nm (36.1 lb.ft.)
PC75R-2
Unit: mm (in.)
No.
Check item
Criteria Cylinder
1
2
3
Clearance between piston rod and bushing
Clearance between cylinder head bushing and pin
Tolerance Shaft
Hole
Standard clearance
Clearance limit
Boom
70 (2.756)
±0.03 (±0.0012) ±0.06 (±0.0024)
+0.2 (0.0079) +0.3 (0.0118)
0.23 ± 0.36 (0.009 ± 0.142)
0.46 (0.0181)
2nd boom (2 pieces)
50 (1.968)
±0.025 (±0.001) ±0.05 (0.002)
+0.2 (0.0079) +0.3 (0.0118)
0.225±0.35 (0.0089±0.0138)
0.45 (0.0177)
Arm
60 (2.362)
±0.03 (±0.0012) ±0.06 (±0.0024)
+0.2 (0.0079) +0.3 (0.0118)
0.23 ± 0.36 (0.009 ± 0.142)
0.46 (0.0181)
Bucket
55 (2.165)
±0.03 (±0.0012) ±0.06 (±0.0024)
+0.2 (0.0079) +0.3 (0.0118)
0.23 ± 0.36 (0.009 ± 0.142)
0.46 (0.0181)
Boom swing
60 (2.362)
±0.03 (±0.0012) ±0.06 (±0.0024)
+0.2 (0.0079) +0.3 (0.0118)
0.23 ± 0.36 (0.009 ± 0.142)
0.46 (0.0181)
Blade
60 (2.362)
±0.03 (±0.0012) ±0.06 (±0.0024)
+0.2 (0.0079) +0.3 (0.0118)
0.23 ± 0.36 (0.009 ± 0.142)
0.46 (0.0181)
Boom
60 (2.362)
±0.06 (±0.0024) +0.1 (0.0039) 0.16±0.252 ±0.106 (0.0042) +0.146 (0.0057) (0.0063±0.0099)
1 (0.0394)
2nd boom (2 pieces)
50 (1.968)
±0.05 (0.002) +0.08 (0.0031) 0.13±0.208 ±0.089 (±0.0035) +0.119 (0.0047) (0.0051±0.0082)
1 (0.0394)
Arm
50 (1.968)
±0.05 (0.002) +0.08 (0.0031) 0.13±0.208 ±0.089 (±0.0035) +0.119 (0.0047) (0.0051±0.0082)
1 (0.0394)
Bucket
50 (1.968)
0.13±0.208 ±0.05 (0.002) +0.08 (0.0031) ±0.089 (±0.0035) +0.119 (0.0047) (0.0051±0.0082)
1 (0.0394)
Boom swing
50 (1.968)
±0.05 (0.002) +0.08 (0.0031) 0.13±0.208 ±0.089 (±0.0035) +0.119 (0.0047) (0.0051±0.0082)
1 (0.0394)
Blade
50 (1.968)
±0.05 (0.002) +0.08 (0.0031) 0.13±0.208 ±0.089 (±0.0035) +0.119 (0.0047) (0.0051±0.0082)
1 (0.0394)
Boom
60 (2.362)
±0.06 (±0.0024) +0.1 (0.0039) 0.16±0.252 ±0.106 (0.0042) +0.146 (0.0057) (0.0063±0.0099)
1 (0.0394)
2nd boom (2 pieces)
60 (2.362)
±0.06 (±0.0024) +0.1 (0.0039) 0.16±0.252 ±0.106 (0.0042) +0.146 (0.0057) (0.0063±0.0099)
1 (0.0394)
50 (1.968)
±0.05 (0.002) +0.08 (0.0031) 0.13±0.208 ±0.089 (±0.0035) +0.119 (0.0047) (0.0051±0.0082)
1 (0.0394)
50 (1.968)
±0.05 (0.002) +0.08 (0.0031) 0.13±0.208 ±0.089 (±0.0035) +0.119 (0.0047) (0.0051±0.0082)
1 (0.0394)
Boom swing
50 (1.968)
0.13±0.208 ±0.05 (0.002) +0.08 (0.0031) ±0.089 (±0.0035) +0.119 (0.0047) (0.0051±0.0082)
1 (0.0394)
Blade
50 (1.968)
±0.05 (0.002) +0.08 (0.0031) 0.13±0.208 ±0.089 (±0.0035) +0.119 (0.0047) (0.0051±0.0082)
1 (0.0394)
Clearance Arm between cylinder bottom bushing Bucket and pin
PC75R-2
Standard size
Remedy
40-33
WORK EQUIPMENT (1-piece boom)
C
E
D B
A
F
7
6
4
Section A - A
5
Section B - B
2
3
Section C - C
8
1
Section D - D
Section E - E
Section F - F RKP08750
40-34
PC75R-2
Unit: mm (in.)
No.
Check item
Criteria Standard size
Tolerance
Remedy Standard Tolerance clearance limit
Shaft
Hole
100 (3.937)
±0.072 (±0.0028) ±0.126 (±0.005)
+0.145 (+0.0057) +0.044 (+0.0017)
0.271± 0.116 (0.0107± 0.0046)
0.8 (0.0315)
1
Clearance between swing bracket-to-revolving frame mounting and pin bushing
2
Clearance between boom-to-swing bracket mounting pin and bushing
60 (2.362)
±0.060 (±0.0024) ±0.106 (±0.0042)
+0.047 (+0.0019) +0.127 (0.005)
0.107± 0.233 (0.0042± 0.0092)
0.8 (0.0315)
3
Clearance between boom-to-arm mounting pin and bushing
60 (2.362)
±0.060 (±0.0024) ±0.106 (±0.0042)
+0.047 (+0.0019) +0.127 (0.005)
0.107± 0.233 (0.0042± 0.0092)
0.8 (0.0315)
4
Clearance between bucket cylinder-to-link mounting pin and link bushing
50 (1.968)
±0.050 (±0.0197) ±0.089 (±0.0035)
+0.095 (0.0374) +0.016 (+0.0006)
0.184± 0.066 (0.0072± 0.0026)
1 (0.0394)
5
Clearance between arm-to-link mounting pin and bushing
50 (1.968)
±0.050 (±0.0197) ±0.089 (±0.0035)
+0.095 (0.0374) +0.016 (+0.0006)
0.184± 0.066 (0.0072± 0.0026)
1 (0.0394)
6
Clearance between bucket-to-arm mounting pin and bushing
50 (1.968)
±0.050 (±0.0197) ±0.089 (±0.0035)
+0.095 (0.0374) +0.016 (+0.0006)
0.184± 0.066 (0.0072± 0.0026)
1 (0.0394)
7
Clearance between bucket-to-link mounting pin and bushing
50 (1.968)
±0.050 (±0.0197) ±0.089 (±0.0035)
+0.095 (0.0374) +0.016 (+0.0006)
0.184± 0.066 (0.0072± 0.0026)
1 (0.0394)
8
Clearance between blade mounting pin and bushing
50 (1.968)
±0.050 (±0.0197) ±0.089 (±0.0035)
+0.095 (0.0374) +0.016 (+0.0006)
0.184± 0.066 (0.0072± 0.0026)
1.5 (0.0591)
PC75R-2
Replace
40-35
WORK EQUIPMENT (2-piece boom) D
C
E
F B
A
G
7
6
Section A - A
9
4
5
3
Section B - B
Section C - C
2
1
Section D - D
Section E - E
Section F - F RKP08760
40-36
PC75R-2
8
Section G - G RKP08770
Unit: mm (in.)
No.
Check item
Criteria Standard size
Tolerance
Remedy Standard Tolerance clearance limit
Shaft
Hole
100 (3.937)
±0.072 (±0.0028) ±0.126 (±0.005)
+0.145 (+0.0057) +0.044 (+0.0017)
0.271± 0.116 (0.0107± 0.0046)
0.8 (0.0315)
1
Clearance between swing bracket-to-revolving frame mounting and pin bushing
2
Clearance between boomto-swing bracket mounting pin and bushing
60 (2.362)
±0.060 (±0.0024) ±0.106 (±0.0042)
+0.047 (+0.0019) +0.127 (0.005)
0.107± 0.233 (0.0042± 0.0092)
0.8 (0.0315)
3
Clearance between boom-to-arm mounting pin and bushing
60 (2.362)
±0.060 (±0.0024) ±0.106 (±0.0042)
+0.047 (+0.0019) +0.127 (0.005)
0.107± 0.233 (0.0042± 0.0092)
0.8 (0.0315)
4
Clearance between bucket cylinder-to-link mounting pin and link bushing
50 (1.968)
±0.050 (±0.0197) ±0.089 (±0.0035)
+0.095 (0.0374) +0.016 (+0.0006)
0.184± 0.066 (0.0072± 0.0026)
1 (0.0394)
5
Clearance between arm-to-link mounting pin and bushing
50 (1.968)
±0.050 (±0.0197) ±0.089 (±0.0035)
+0.095 (0.0374) +0.016 (+0.0006)
0.184± 0.066 (0.0072± 0.0026)
1 (0.0394)
6
Clearance between bucket-to-arm mounting pin and bushing
50 (1.968)
±0.050 (±0.0197) ±0.089 (±0.0035)
+0.095 (0.0374) +0.016 (+0.0006)
0.184± 0.066 (0.0072± 0.0026)
1 (0.0394)
7
Clearance between bucket-to-link mounting pin and bushing
50 (1.968)
±0.050 (±0.0197) ±0.089 (±0.0035)
+0.095 (0.0374) +0.016 (+0.0006)
0.184± 0.066 (0.0072± 0.0026)
1 (0.0394)
8
Clearance between blade fulcrum pin and bushing
50 (1.968)
±0.050 (±0.0197) ±0.089 (±0.0035)
+0.095 (0.0374) +0.016 (+0.0006)
0.184± 0.066 (0.0072± 0.0026)
1.5 (0.0591)
9
Clearance between bushing and mounting pin of 2nd boom
60 (2.362)
±0.060 (±0.0024) ±0.106 (±0.0042)
+0.047 (+0.0019) +0.127 (0.005)
0.107± 0.233 (0.0042± 0.0092)
0.8 (0.0315)
PC75R-2
Replace
40-37